<!doctype html public "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN" "http://www.w3.org/TR/html4/loose.dtd"> <html> <head> <title>Postfix Configuration Parameters </title> <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=us-ascii"> </head> <body> <h1><img src="postfix-logo.jpg" width="203" height="98" alt="">Postfix Configuration Parameters </h1> <hr> <h2> Postfix main.cf file format </h2> <p> The Postfix main.cf configuration file specifies a very small subset of all the parameters that control the operation of the Postfix mail system. Parameters not explicitly specified are left at their default values. </p> <p> The general format of the main.cf file is as follows: </p> <ul> <li> <p> Each logical line is in the form "parameter = value". Whitespace around the "=" is ignored, as is whitespace at the end of a logical line. </p> <li> <p> Empty lines and whitespace-only lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is a `#'. </p> <li> <p> A logical line starts with non-whitespace text. A line that starts with whitespace continues a logical line. </p> <li> <p> A parameter value may refer to other parameters. </p> <ul> <li> <p> The expressions "$name", "${name}" or "$(name)" are recursively replaced by the value of the named parameter. </p> <li> <p> The expression "${name?value}" expands to "value" when "$name" is non-empty. This form is supported with Postfix version 2.2 and later. </p> <li> <p> The expression "${name:value}" expands to "value" when "$name" is empty. This form is supported with Postfix version 2.2 and later. </p> </ul> <li> <p> When the same parameter is defined multiple times, only the last instance is remembered. </p> <li> <p> Otherwise, the order of main.cf parameter definitions does not matter. </p> </ul> <p> The remainder of this document is a description of all Postfix configuration parameters. Default values are shown after the parameter name in parentheses, and can be looked up with the "<b>postconf -d</b>" command. </p> <p> Note: this is not an invitation to make changes to Postfix configuration parameters. Unnecessary changes are likely to impair the operation of the mail system. </p> <dl> <DT><b><a name="2bounce_notice_recipient">2bounce_notice_recipient</a> (default: postmaster)</b></DT><DD> <p> The recipient of undeliverable mail that cannot be returned to the sender. This feature is enabled with the <a href="postconf.5.html#notify_classes">notify_classes</a> parameter. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="access_map_reject_code">access_map_reject_code</a> (default: 554)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a client is rejected by an <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> map restriction. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_default_transport">address_verify_default_transport</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_transport">default_transport</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html#default_transport">default_transport</a> parameter setting for address verification probes. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_local_transport">address_verify_local_transport</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_transport">local_transport</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html#local_transport">local_transport</a> parameter setting for address verification probes. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_map">address_verify_map</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup table for persistent address verification status storage. The table is maintained by the <a href="verify.8.html">verify(8)</a> service, and is opened before the process releases privileges. </p> <p> By default, the information is kept in volatile memory, and is lost after "<b>postfix reload</b>" or "<b>postfix stop</b>". </p> <p> Specify a location in a file system that will not fill up. If the database becomes corrupted, the world comes to an end. To recover delete the file and do "<b>postfix reload</b>". </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#address_verify_map">address_verify_map</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/verify <a href="postconf.5.html#address_verify_map">address_verify_map</a> = btree:/etc/postfix/verify </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_negative_cache">address_verify_negative_cache</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable caching of failed address verification probe results. When this feature is enabled, the cache may pollute quickly with garbage. When this feature is disabled, Postfix will generate an address probe for every lookup. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_negative_expire_time">address_verify_negative_expire_time</a> (default: 3d)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which a failed probe expires from the address verification cache. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_negative_refresh_time">address_verify_negative_refresh_time</a> (default: 3h)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which a failed address verification probe needs to be refreshed. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_poll_count">address_verify_poll_count</a> (default: 3)</b></DT><DD> <p> How many times to query the <a href="verify.8.html">verify(8)</a> service for the completion of an address verification request in progress. </p> <p> The default poll count is 3. </p> <p> Specify 1 to implement a crude form of greylisting, that is, always defer the first delivery request for a never seen before address. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#address_verify_poll_count">address_verify_poll_count</a> = 1 </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_poll_delay">address_verify_poll_delay</a> (default: 3s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The delay between queries for the completion of an address verification request in progress. </p> <p> The default polling delay is 3 seconds. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_positive_expire_time">address_verify_positive_expire_time</a> (default: 31d)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which a successful probe expires from the address verification cache. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_positive_refresh_time">address_verify_positive_refresh_time</a> (default: 7d)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which a successful address verification probe needs to be refreshed. The address verification status is not updated when the probe fails (optimistic caching). </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_relay_transport">address_verify_relay_transport</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a> parameter setting for address verification probes. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_relayhost">address_verify_relayhost</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a> parameter setting for address verification probes. This information can be overruled with the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_sender">address_verify_sender</a> (default: postmaster)</b></DT><DD> <p> The sender address to use in address verification probes. To avoid problems with address probes that are sent in response to address probes, the Postfix SMTP server excludes the probe sender address from all SMTPD access blocks. </p> <p> Specify an empty value (<a href="postconf.5.html#address_verify_sender">address_verify_sender</a> =) or <> if you want to use the null sender address. Beware, some sites reject mail from <>, even though RFCs require that such addresses be accepted. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#address_verify_sender">address_verify_sender</a> = <> <a href="postconf.5.html#address_verify_sender">address_verify_sender</a> = postmaster@my.domain </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_sender_dependent_relayhost_maps">address_verify_sender_dependent_relayhost_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html#sender_dependent_relayhost_maps">sender_dependent_relayhost_maps</a> parameter setting for address verification probes. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_service_name">address_verify_service_name</a> (default: verify)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="verify.8.html">verify(8)</a> address verification service. This service maintains the status of sender and/or recipient address verification probes, and generates probes on request by other Postfix processes. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_transport_maps">address_verify_transport_maps</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#transport_maps">transport_maps</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html#transport_maps">transport_maps</a> parameter setting for address verification probes. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="address_verify_virtual_transport">address_verify_virtual_transport</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_transport">virtual_transport</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_transport">virtual_transport</a> parameter setting for address verification probes. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="alias_database">alias_database</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The alias databases for <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery that are updated with "<b>newaliases</b>" or with "<b>sendmail -bi</b>". </p> <p> This is a separate configuration parameter because not all the tables specified with $<a href="postconf.5.html#alias_maps">alias_maps</a> have to be local files. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#alias_database">alias_database</a> = hash:/etc/aliases <a href="postconf.5.html#alias_database">alias_database</a> = hash:/etc/mail/aliases </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="alias_maps">alias_maps</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The alias databases that are used for <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery. See <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> for syntax details. </p> <p> The default list is system dependent. On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias database, then the NIS alias database. </p> <p> If you change the alias database, run "<b>postalias /etc/aliases</b>" (or wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run "<b>newaliases</b>" to build the necessary DBM or DB file. </p> <p> The <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution of $1 etc. in <a href="postconf.5.html#alias_maps">alias_maps</a>, because that would open a security hole. </p> <p> The <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent will silently ignore requests to use the <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxymap(8)</a> server within <a href="postconf.5.html#alias_maps">alias_maps</a>. Instead it will open the table directly. Before Postfix version 2.2, the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#alias_maps">alias_maps</a> = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases <a href="postconf.5.html#alias_maps">alias_maps</a> = hash:/etc/aliases </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="allow_mail_to_commands">allow_mail_to_commands</a> (default: alias, forward)</b></DT><DD> <p> Restrict <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> mail delivery to external commands. The default is to disallow delivery to "|command" in :include: files (see <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> for the text that defines this terminology). </p> <p> Specify zero or more of: <b>alias</b>, <b>forward</b> or <b>include</b>, in order to allow commands in <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a>, .forward files or in :include: files, respectively. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#allow_mail_to_commands">allow_mail_to_commands</a> = alias,forward,include </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="allow_mail_to_files">allow_mail_to_files</a> (default: alias, forward)</b></DT><DD> <p> Restrict <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> mail delivery to external files. The default is to disallow "/file/name" destinations in :include: files (see <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> for the text that defines this terminology). </p> <p> Specify zero or more of: <b>alias</b>, <b>forward</b> or <b>include</b>, in order to allow "/file/name" destinations in <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a>, .forward files and in :include: files, respectively. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#allow_mail_to_files">allow_mail_to_files</a> = alias,forward,include </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="allow_min_user">allow_min_user</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Allow a recipient address to have `-' as the first character. By default, this is not allowed, to avoid accidents with software that passes email addresses via the command line. Such software would not be able to distinguish a malicious address from a bona fide command-line option. Although this can be prevented by inserting a "--" option terminator into the command line, this is difficult to enforce consistently and globally. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="allow_percent_hack">allow_percent_hack</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable the rewriting of the form "user%domain" to "user@domain". This is enabled by default. </p> <p> Note: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting happens only when one of the following conditions is true: </p> <ul> <li> The message is received with the Postfix <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command, <li> The message is received from a network client that matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a>, <li> The message is received from the network, and the <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> parameter specifies a non-empty value. </ul> <p> To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = static:all". </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#allow_percent_hack">allow_percent_hack</a> = no </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="allow_untrusted_routing">allow_untrusted_routing</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Forward mail with sender-specified routing (user[@%!]remote[@%!]site) from untrusted clients to destinations matching $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a>. </p> <p> By default, this feature is turned off. This closes a nasty open relay loophole where a backup MX host can be tricked into forwarding junk mail to a primary MX host which then spams it out to the world. </p> <p> This parameter also controls if non-local addresses with sender-specified routing can match Postfix access tables. By default, such addresses cannot match Postfix access tables, because the address is ambiguous. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="alternate_config_directories">alternate_config_directories</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> A list of non-default Postfix configuration directories that may be specified with "-c <a href="postconf.5.html#config_directory">config_directory</a>" on the command line, or via the MAIL_CONFIG environment parameter. </p> <p> This list must be specified in the default Postfix configuration directory, and is used by set-gid Postfix commands such as <a href="postqueue.1.html">postqueue(1)</a> and <a href="postdrop.1.html">postdrop(1)</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="always_bcc">always_bcc</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional address that receives a "blind carbon copy" of each message that is received by the Postfix mail system. </p> <p> Note: if mail to the BCC address bounces it will be returned to the sender. </p> <p> Note: automatic BCC recipients are produced only for new mail. To avoid mailer loops, automatic BCC recipients are not generated for mail that Postfix forwards internally, nor for mail that Postfix generates itself. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="anvil_rate_time_unit">anvil_rate_time_unit</a> (default: 60s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time unit over which client connection rates and other rates are calculated. </p> <p> This feature is implemented by the <a href="anvil.8.html">anvil(8)</a> service which is available in Postfix version 2.2 and later. </p> <p> The default interval is relatively short. Because of the high frequency of updates, the <a href="anvil.8.html">anvil(8)</a> server uses volatile memory only. Thus, information is lost whenever the process terminates. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="anvil_status_update_time">anvil_status_update_time</a> (default: 600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> How frequently the <a href="anvil.8.html">anvil(8)</a> connection and rate limiting server logs peak usage information. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="append_at_myorigin">append_at_myorigin</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> With locally submitted mail, append the string "@$<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a>" to mail addresses without domain information. With remotely submitted mail, append the string "@$<a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a>" instead. </p> <p> Note 1: this feature is enabled by default and must not be turned off. Postfix does not support domain-less addresses. </p> <p> Note 2: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting happens only when one of the following conditions is true: </p> <ul> <li> The message is received with the Postfix <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command, <li> The message is received from a network client that matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a>, <li> The message is received from the network, and the <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> parameter specifies a non-empty value. </ul> <p> To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = static:all". </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="append_dot_mydomain">append_dot_mydomain</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> With locally submitted mail, append the string ".$<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a>" to addresses that have no ".domain" information. With remotely submitted mail, append the string ".$<a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a>" instead. </p> <p> Note 1: this feature is enabled by default. If disabled, users will not be able to send mail to "user@partialdomainname" but will have to specify full domain names instead. </p> <p> Note 2: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting happens only when one of the following conditions is true: </p> <ul> <li> The message is received with the Postfix <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command, <li> The message is received from a network client that matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a>, <li> The message is received from the network, and the <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> parameter specifies a non-empty value. </ul> <p> To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = static:all". </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="application_event_drain_time">application_event_drain_time</a> (default: 100s)</b></DT><DD> <p> How long the <a href="postkick.1.html">postkick(1)</a> command waits for a request to enter the server's input buffer before giving up. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="authorized_flush_users">authorized_flush_users</a> (default: static:anyone)</b></DT><DD> <p> List of users who are authorized to flush the queue. </p> <p> By default, all users are allowed to flush the queue. Access is always granted if the invoking user is the super-user or the $<a href="postconf.5.html#mail_owner">mail_owner</a> user. Otherwise, the real UID of the process is looked up in the system password file, and access is granted only if the corresponding login name is on the access list. The username "unknown" is used for processes whose real UID is not found in the password file. </p> <p> Specify a list of user names, "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The list is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="authorized_mailq_users">authorized_mailq_users</a> (default: static:anyone)</b></DT><DD> <p> List of users who are authorized to view the queue. </p> <p> By default, all users are allowed to view the queue. Access is always granted if the invoking user is the super-user or the $<a href="postconf.5.html#mail_owner">mail_owner</a> user. Otherwise, the real UID of the process is looked up in the system password file, and access is granted only if the corresponding login name is on the access list. The username "unknown" is used for processes whose real UID is not found in the password file. </p> <p> Specify a list of user names, "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The list is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a user name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="authorized_submit_users">authorized_submit_users</a> (default: static:anyone)</b></DT><DD> <p> List of users who are authorized to submit mail with the <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command (and with the privileged <a href="postdrop.1.html">postdrop(1)</a> helper command). </p> <p> By default, all users are allowed to submit mail. Otherwise, the real UID of the process is looked up in the system password file, and access is granted only if the corresponding login name is on the access list. The username "unknown" is used for processes whose real UID is not found in the password file. To deny mail submission access to all users specify an empty list. </p> <p> Specify a list of user names, "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The list is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a user name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#authorized_submit_users">authorized_submit_users</a> = !www, static:all </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="authorized_verp_clients">authorized_verp_clients</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> What SMTP clients are allowed to specify the XVERP command. This command requests that mail be delivered one recipient at a time with a per recipient return address. </p> <p> By default, only trusted clients are allowed to specify XVERP. </p> <p> This parameter was introduced with Postfix version 1.1. Postfix version 2.1 renamed this parameter to <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_authorized_verp_clients">smtpd_authorized_verp_clients</a> and changed the default to none. </p> <p> Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it), "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside <tt>[]</tt> in the <a href="postconf.5.html#authorized_verp_clients">authorized_verp_clients</a> value, and in files specified with "/file/name". IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be confused with a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" pattern. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="backwards_bounce_logfile_compatibility">backwards_bounce_logfile_compatibility</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Produce additional <a href="bounce.8.html">bounce(8)</a> logfile records that can be read by Postfix versions before 2.0. The current and more extensible "name = value" format is needed in order to implement more sophisticated functionality. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="berkeley_db_create_buffer_size">berkeley_db_create_buffer_size</a> (default: 16777216)</b></DT><DD> <p> The per-table I/O buffer size for programs that create Berkeley DB hash or btree tables. Specify a byte count. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="berkeley_db_read_buffer_size">berkeley_db_read_buffer_size</a> (default: 131072)</b></DT><DD> <p> The per-table I/O buffer size for programs that read Berkeley DB hash or btree tables. Specify a byte count. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="best_mx_transport">best_mx_transport</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Where the Postfix SMTP client should deliver mail when it detects a "mail loops back to myself" error condition. This happens when the local MTA is the best SMTP mail exchanger for a destination not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a>, or $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a>. By default, the Postfix SMTP client returns such mail as undeliverable. </p> <p> Specify, for example, "<a href="postconf.5.html#best_mx_transport">best_mx_transport</a> = local" to pass the mail from the Postfix SMTP client to the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent. You can specify any message delivery "transport" or "transport:nexthop" that is defined in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. See the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> manual page for the syntax and meaning of "transport" or "transport:nexthop". </p> <p> However, this feature is expensive because it ties up a Postfix SMTP client process while the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent is doing its work. It is more efficient (for Postfix) to list all <a href="VIRTUAL_README.html#canonical">hosted domains</a> in a table or database. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="biff">biff</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Whether or not to use the local <a href="postconf.5.html#biff">biff</a> service. This service sends "new mail" notifications to users who have requested new mail notification with the UNIX command "<a href="postconf.5.html#biff">biff</a> y". </p> <p> For compatibility reasons this feature is on by default. On systems with lots of interactive users, the <a href="postconf.5.html#biff">biff</a> service can be a performance drain. Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#biff">biff</a> = no" in <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> to disable. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="body_checks">body_checks</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables for content inspection as specified in the <a href="header_checks.5.html">body_checks(5)</a> manual page. </p> <p> Note: with Postfix versions before 2.0, these rules inspect all content after the primary message headers. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="body_checks_size_limit">body_checks_size_limit</a> (default: 51200)</b></DT><DD> <p> How much text in a message body segment (or attachment, if you prefer to use that term) is subjected to <a href="postconf.5.html#body_checks">body_checks</a> inspection. The amount of text is limited to avoid scanning huge attachments. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="bounce_notice_recipient">bounce_notice_recipient</a> (default: postmaster)</b></DT><DD> <p> The recipient of postmaster notifications with the message headers of mail that Postfix did not deliver and of SMTP conversation transcripts of mail that Postfix did not receive. This feature is enabled with the <a href="postconf.5.html#notify_classes">notify_classes</a> parameter. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="bounce_queue_lifetime">bounce_queue_lifetime</a> (default: 5d)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal time a bounce message is queued before it is considered undeliverable. By default, this is the same as the queue life time for regular mail. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is d (days). </p> <p> Specify 0 when mail delivery should be tried only once. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="bounce_service_name">bounce_service_name</a> (default: bounce)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="bounce.8.html">bounce(8)</a> service. This service maintains a record of failed delivery attempts and generates non-delivery notifications. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="bounce_size_limit">bounce_size_limit</a> (default: 50000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal amount of original message text that is sent in a non-delivery notification. Specify a byte count. If you increase this limit, then you should increase the <a href="postconf.5.html#mime_nesting_limit">mime_nesting_limit</a> value proportionally. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="bounce_template_file">bounce_template_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Pathname of a configuration file with bounce message templates. These override the built-in templates of delivery status notification (DSN) messages for undeliverable mail, for delayed mail, successful delivery, or delivery verification. The <a href="bounce.5.html">bounce(5)</a> manual page describes how to edit and test template files. </p> <p> Template message body text may contain $name references to Postfix configuration parameters. The result of $name expansion can be previewed with "<b>postconf -b <i>file_name</i></b>" before the file is placed into the Postfix configuration directory. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="broken_sasl_auth_clients">broken_sasl_auth_clients</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable inter-operability with SMTP clients that implement an obsolete version of the AUTH command (<a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc2554.html">RFC 2554</a>). Examples of such clients are MicroSoft Outlook Express version 4 and MicroSoft Exchange version 5.0. </p> <p> Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#broken_sasl_auth_clients">broken_sasl_auth_clients</a> = yes" to have Postfix advertise AUTH support in a non-standard way. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="canonical_classes">canonical_classes</a> (default: envelope_sender, envelope_recipient, header_sender, header_recipient)</b></DT><DD> <p> What addresses are subject to <a href="postconf.5.html#canonical_maps">canonical_maps</a> address mapping. By default, <a href="postconf.5.html#canonical_maps">canonical_maps</a> address mapping is applied to envelope sender and recipient addresses, and to header sender and header recipient addresses. </p> <p> Specify one or more of: envelope_sender, envelope_recipient, header_sender, header_recipient </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="canonical_maps">canonical_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional address mapping lookup tables for message headers and envelopes. The mapping is applied to both sender and recipient addresses, in both envelopes and in headers, as controlled with the <a href="postconf.5.html#canonical_classes">canonical_classes</a> parameter. This is typically used to clean up dirty addresses from legacy mail systems, or to replace login names by Firstname.Lastname. The table format and lookups are documented in <a href="canonical.5.html">canonical(5)</a>. For an overview of Postfix address manipulations see the <a href="ADDRESS_REWRITING_README.html">ADDRESS_REWRITING_README</a> document. </p> <p> If you use this feature, run "<b>postmap /etc/postfix/canonical</b>" to build the necessary DBM or DB file after every change. The changes will become visible after a minute or so. Use "<b>postfix reload</b>" to eliminate the delay. </p> <p> Note: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address mapping happens only when message header address rewriting is enabled: </p> <ul> <li> The message is received with the Postfix <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command, <li> The message is received from a network client that matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a>, <li> The message is received from the network, and the <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> parameter specifies a non-empty value. </ul> <p> To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = static:all". </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#canonical_maps">canonical_maps</a> = dbm:/etc/postfix/canonical <a href="postconf.5.html#canonical_maps">canonical_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/canonical </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="cleanup_service_name">cleanup_service_name</a> (default: cleanup)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="cleanup.8.html">cleanup(8)</a> service. This service rewrites addresses into the standard form, and performs <a href="canonical.5.html">canonical(5)</a> address mapping and <a href="virtual.5.html">virtual(5)</a> aliasing. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="command_directory">command_directory</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The location of all postfix administrative commands. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="command_execution_directory">command_execution_directory</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent working directory for delivery to external command. Failure to change directory causes the delivery to be deferred. </p> <p> The following $name expansions are done on <a href="postconf.5.html#command_execution_directory">command_execution_directory</a> before the directory is changed. Expansion happens in the context of the delivery request. The result of $name expansion is filtered with the character set that is specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#execution_directory_expansion_filter">execution_directory_expansion_filter</a> parameter. </p> <dl> <dt><b>$user</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's username. </dd> <dt><b>$shell</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's login shell pathname. </dd> <dt><b>$home</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's home directory. </dd> <dt><b>$recipient</b></dt> <dd>The full recipient address. </dd> <dt><b>$extension</b></dt> <dd>The optional recipient address extension. </dd> <dt><b>$domain</b></dt> <dd>The recipient domain. </dd> <dt><b>$local</b></dt> <dd>The entire recipient localpart. </dd> <dt><b>$<a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_delimiter">recipient_delimiter</a></b></dt> <dd>The system-wide recipient address extension delimiter. </dd> <dt><b>${name?value}</b></dt> <dd>Expands to <i>value</i> when <i>$name</i> is non-empty. </dd> <dt><b>${name:value}</b></dt> <dd>Expands to <i>value</i> when <i>$name</i> is empty. </dd> </dl> <p> Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="command_expansion_filter">command_expansion_filter</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> Restrict the characters that the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent allows in $name expansions of $<a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>. Characters outside the allowed set are replaced by underscores. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="command_time_limit">command_time_limit</a> (default: 1000s)</b></DT><DD> <p> Time limit for delivery to external commands. This limit is used by the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent, and is the default time limit for delivery by the <a href="pipe.8.html">pipe(8)</a> delivery agent. </p> <p> Note: if you set this time limit to a large value you must update the global <a href="postconf.5.html#ipc_timeout">ipc_timeout</a> parameter as well. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="config_directory">config_directory</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default location of the Postfix <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> and <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> configuration files. This can be overruled via the following mechanisms: </p> <ul> <li> <p> The MAIL_CONFIG environment variable (daemon processes and commands). </p> <li> <p> The "-c" command-line option (commands only). </p> </ul> <p> With Postfix command that run with set-gid privileges, a <a href="postconf.5.html#config_directory">config_directory</a> override requires either root privileges, or it requires that the directory is listed with the <a href="postconf.5.html#alternate_config_directories">alternate_config_directories</a> parameter in the default <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> file. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="connection_cache_protocol_timeout">connection_cache_protocol_timeout</a> (default: 5s)</b></DT><DD> <p> Time limit for connection cache connect, send or receive operations. The time limit is enforced in the client. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="connection_cache_service">connection_cache_service</a> (default: scache)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="scache.8.html">scache(8)</a> connection cache service. This service maintains a limited pool of cached sessions. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="connection_cache_status_update_time">connection_cache_status_update_time</a> (default: 600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> How frequently the <a href="scache.8.html">scache(8)</a> server logs usage statistics with connection cache hit and miss rates for logical destinations and for physical endpoints. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="connection_cache_ttl_limit">connection_cache_ttl_limit</a> (default: 2s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal time-to-live value that the <a href="scache.8.html">scache(8)</a> connection cache server allows. Requests that specify a larger TTL will be stored with the maximum allowed TTL. The purpose of this additional control is to protect the infrastructure against careless people. The cache TTL is already bounded by $<a href="postconf.5.html#max_idle">max_idle</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="content_filter">content_filter</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of a mail delivery transport that filters mail after it is queued. </p> <p> This parameter uses the same syntax as the right-hand side of a Postfix <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. This setting has a lower precedence than a content filter that is specified with an <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> table or in a <a href="header_checks.5.html">header_checks(5)</a> or <a href="header_checks.5.html">body_checks(5)</a> table. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="daemon_directory">daemon_directory</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The directory with Postfix support programs and daemon programs. These should not be invoked directly by humans. The directory must be owned by root. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="daemon_timeout">daemon_timeout</a> (default: 18000s)</b></DT><DD> <p> How much time a Postfix daemon process may take to handle a request before it is terminated by a built-in watchdog timer. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="debug_peer_level">debug_peer_level</a> (default: 2)</b></DT><DD> <p> The increment in verbose logging level when a remote client or server matches a pattern in the <a href="postconf.5.html#debug_peer_list">debug_peer_list</a> parameter. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="debug_peer_list">debug_peer_list</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional list of remote client or server hostname or network address patterns that cause the verbose logging level to increase by the amount specified in $<a href="postconf.5.html#debug_peer_level">debug_peer_level</a>. </p> <p> Specify domain names, network/netmask patterns, "/file/name" patterns or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup tables. The right-hand side result from "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookups is ignored. </p> <p> Pattern matching of domain names is controlled by the <a href="postconf.5.html#parent_domain_matches_subdomains">parent_domain_matches_subdomains</a> parameter. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#debug_peer_list">debug_peer_list</a> = 127.0.0.1 <a href="postconf.5.html#debug_peer_list">debug_peer_list</a> = some.domain </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="debugger_command">debugger_command</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The external command to execute when a Postfix daemon program is invoked with the -D option. </p> <p> Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#debugger_command">debugger_command</a> = PATH=/usr/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin xxgdb $<a href="postconf.5.html#daemon_directory">daemon_directory</a>/$<a href="postconf.5.html#process_name">process_name</a> $<a href="postconf.5.html#process_id">process_id</a> & sleep 5 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_database_type">default_database_type</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default database type for use in <a href="newaliases.1.html">newaliases(1)</a>, <a href="postalias.1.html">postalias(1)</a> and <a href="postmap.1.html">postmap(1)</a> commands. On many UNIX systems the default type is either <b>dbm</b> or <b>hash</b>. The default setting is frozen when the Postfix system is built. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#default_database_type">default_database_type</a> = hash <a href="postconf.5.html#default_database_type">default_database_type</a> = dbm </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_delivery_slot_cost">default_delivery_slot_cost</a> (default: 5)</b></DT><DD> <p> How often the Postfix queue manager's scheduler is allowed to preempt delivery of one message with another. </p> <p> Each transport maintains a so-called "available delivery slot counter" for each message. One message can be preempted by another one when the other message can be delivered using no more delivery slots (i.e., invocations of delivery agents) than the current message counter has accumulated (or will eventually accumulate - see about slot loans below). This parameter controls how often is the counter incremented - it happens after each <a href="postconf.5.html#default_delivery_slot_cost">default_delivery_slot_cost</a> recipients have been delivered. </p> <p> The cost of 0 is used to disable the preempting scheduling completely. The minimum value the scheduling algorithm can use is 2 - use it if you want to maximize the message throughput rate. Although there is no maximum, it doesn't make much sense to use values above say 50. </p> <p> The only reason why the value of 2 is not the default is the way this parameter affects the delivery of mailing-list mail. In the worst case, their delivery can take somewhere between (cost+1/cost) and (cost/cost-1) times more than if the preemptive scheduler was disabled. The default value of 5 turns out to provide reasonable message response times while making sure the mailing-list deliveries are not extended by more than 20-25 percent even in the worst case. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#default_delivery_slot_cost">default_delivery_slot_cost</a> = 0 <a href="postconf.5.html#default_delivery_slot_cost">default_delivery_slot_cost</a> = 2 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_delivery_slot_discount">default_delivery_slot_discount</a> (default: 50)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default value for transport-specific _delivery_slot_discount settings. </p> <p> This parameter speeds up the moment when a message preemption can happen. Instead of waiting until the full amount of delivery slots required is available, the preemption can happen when transport_delivery_slot_discount percent of the required amount plus transport_delivery_slot_loan still remains to be accumulated. Note that the full amount will still have to be accumulated before another preemption can take place later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_delivery_slot_loan">default_delivery_slot_loan</a> (default: 3)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default value for transport-specific _delivery_slot_loan settings. </p> <p> This parameter speeds up the moment when a message preemption can happen. Instead of waiting until the full amount of delivery slots required is available, the preemption can happen when transport_delivery_slot_discount percent of the required amount plus transport_delivery_slot_loan still remains to be accumulated. Note that the full amount will still have to be accumulated before another preemption can take place later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_destination_concurrency_limit">default_destination_concurrency_limit</a> (default: 20)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same destination. This is the default limit for delivery via the <a href="lmtp.8.html">lmtp(8)</a>, <a href="pipe.8.html">pipe(8)</a>, <a href="smtp.8.html">smtp(8)</a> and <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agents. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_destination_recipient_limit">default_destination_recipient_limit</a> (default: 50)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default maximal number of recipients per message delivery. This is the default limit for delivery via the <a href="lmtp.8.html">lmtp(8)</a>, <a href="pipe.8.html">pipe(8)</a>, <a href="smtp.8.html">smtp(8)</a> and <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agents. </p> <p> Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the meaning of the corresponding per-destination concurrency limit from concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_extra_recipient_limit">default_extra_recipient_limit</a> (default: 1000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default value for the extra per-transport limit imposed on the number of in-memory recipients. This extra recipient space is reserved for the cases when the Postfix queue manager's scheduler preempts one message with another and suddenly needs some extra recipients slots for the chosen message in order to avoid performance degradation. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_minimum_delivery_slots">default_minimum_delivery_slots</a> (default: 3)</b></DT><DD> <p> How many recipients a message must have in order to invoke the Postfix queue manager's scheduling algorithm at all. Messages which would never accumulate at least this many delivery slots (subject to slot cost parameter as well) are never preempted. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_privs">default_privs</a> (default: nobody)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default rights used by the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent for delivery to external file or command. These rights are used when delivery is requested from an <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> file that is owned by <b>root</b>, or when delivery is done on behalf of <b>root</b>. <b>DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER</b>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_process_limit">default_process_limit</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default maximal number of Postfix child processes that provide a given service. This limit can be overruled for specific services in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_rbl_reply">default_rbl_reply</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default SMTP server response template for a request that is rejected by an RBL-based restriction. This template can be overruled by specific entries in the optional <a href="postconf.5.html#rbl_reply_maps">rbl_reply_maps</a> lookup table. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> <p> The template is subject to exactly one level of $name substitution: </p> <dl> <dt><b>$client</b></dt> <dd>The client hostname and IP address, formatted as name[address]. </dd> <dt><b>$client_address</b></dt> <dd>The client IP address. </dd> <dt><b>$client_name</b></dt> <dd>The client hostname or "unknown". See <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_client_hostname">reject_unknown_client_hostname</a> for more details. </dd> <dt><b>$reverse_client_name</b></dt> <dd>The client hostname from address->name lookup, or "unknown". See <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname">reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname</a> for more details. </dd> <dt><b>$helo_name</b></dt> <dd>The hostname given in HELO or EHLO command or empty string. </dd> <dt><b>$rbl_class</b></dt> <dd>The blacklisted entity type: Client host, Helo command, Sender address, or Recipient address. </dd> <dt><b>$rbl_code</b></dt> <dd>The numerical SMTP response code, as specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#maps_rbl_reject_code">maps_rbl_reject_code</a> configuration parameter. Note: The numerical SMTP response code is required, and must appear at the start of the reply. With Postfix version 2.3 and later this information may be followed by an <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc3463.html">RFC 3463</a> enhanced status code. </dd> <dt><b>$rbl_domain</b></dt> <dd>The RBL domain where $rbl_what is blacklisted. </dd> <dt><b>$rbl_reason</b></dt> <dd>The reason why $rbl_what is blacklisted, or an empty string. </dd> <dt><b>$rbl_what</b></dt> <dd>The entity that is blacklisted (an IP address, a hostname, a domain name, or an email address whose domain was blacklisted). </dd> <dt><b>$recipient</b></dt> <dd>The recipient address or <> in case of the null address. </dd> <dt><b>$recipient_domain</b></dt> <dd>The recipient domain or empty string. </dd> <dt><b>$recipient_name</b></dt> <dd>The recipient address localpart or <> in case of null address. </dd> <dt><b>$sender</b></dt> <dd>The sender address or <> in case of the null address. </dd> <dt><b>$sender_domain</b></dt> <dd>The sender domain or empty string. </dd> <dt><b>$sender_name</b></dt> <dd>The sender address localpart or <> in case of the null address. </dd> <dt><b>${name?text}</b></dt> <dd>Expands to `text' if $name is not empty. </dd> <dt><b>${name:text}</b></dt> <dd>Expands to `text' if $name is empty. </dd> </dl> <p> Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name). </p> <p> Note: when an enhanced status code is specified in an RBL reply template, it is subject to modification. The following transformations are needed when the same RBL reply template is used for client, helo, sender, or recipient access restrictions. </p> <ul> <li> <p> When rejecting a sender address, the Postfix SMTP server will transform a recipient DSN status (e.g., 4.1.1-4.1.6) into the corresponding sender DSN status, and vice versa. </p> <li> <p> When rejecting non-address information (such as the HELO command argument or the client hostname/address), the Postfix SMTP server will transform a sender or recipient DSN status into a generic non-address DSN status (e.g., 4.0.0). </p> </ul> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_recipient_limit">default_recipient_limit</a> (default: 20000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default per-transport upper limit on the number of in-memory recipients. These limits take priority over the global <a href="postconf.5.html#qmgr_message_recipient_limit">qmgr_message_recipient_limit</a> after the message has been assigned to the respective transports. See also <a href="postconf.5.html#default_extra_recipient_limit">default_extra_recipient_limit</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#qmgr_message_recipient_minimum">qmgr_message_recipient_minimum</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_recipient_refill_delay">default_recipient_refill_delay</a> (default: 5s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default per-transport maximum delay between recipients refills. When not all message recipients fit into the memory at once, keep loading more of them at least once every this many seconds. This is used to make sure the recipients are refilled in timely manner even when $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_recipient_refill_limit">default_recipient_refill_limit</a> is too high for too slow deliveries. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_recipient_refill_limit">default_recipient_refill_limit</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default per-transport limit on the number of recipients refilled at once. When not all message recipients fit into the memory at once, keep loading more of them in batches of at least this many at a time. See also $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_recipient_refill_delay">default_recipient_refill_delay</a>, which may result in recipient batches lower than this when this limit is too high for too slow deliveries. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_transport">default_transport</a> (default: smtp)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for destinations that do not match $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a>, or $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a>. In order of decreasing precedence, the nexthop destination is taken from $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_transport">default_transport</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#sender_dependent_relayhost_maps">sender_dependent_relayhost_maps</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a>, or from the recipient domain. This information can be overruled with the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. </p> <p> Specify a string of the form <i>transport:nexthop</i>, where <i>transport</i> is the name of a mail delivery transport defined in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>. The <i>:nexthop</i> part is optional. For more details see the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> manual page. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#default_transport">default_transport</a> = uucp:relayhostname </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="default_verp_delimiters">default_verp_delimiters</a> (default: +=)</b></DT><DD> <p> The two default VERP delimiter characters. These are used when no explicit delimiters are specified with the SMTP XVERP command or with the "<b>sendmail -V</b>" command-line option. Specify characters that are allowed by the <a href="postconf.5.html#verp_delimiter_filter">verp_delimiter_filter</a> setting. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="defer_code">defer_code</a> (default: 450)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a remote SMTP client request is rejected by the "defer" restriction. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="defer_service_name">defer_service_name</a> (default: defer)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the defer service. This service is implemented by the <a href="bounce.8.html">bounce(8)</a> daemon and maintains a record of failed delivery attempts and generates non-delivery notifications. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="defer_transports">defer_transports</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The names of message delivery transports that should not deliver mail unless someone issues "<b>sendmail -q</b>" or equivalent. Specify zero or more names of mail delivery transports names that appear in the first field of <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#defer_transports">defer_transports</a> = smtp </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="delay_logging_resolution_limit">delay_logging_resolution_limit</a> (default: 2)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of digits after the decimal point when logging sub-second delay values. Specify a number in the range 0..6. </p> <p> Large delay values are rounded off to an integral number seconds; delay values below the <a href="postconf.5.html#delay_logging_resolution_limit">delay_logging_resolution_limit</a> are logged as "0", and small delay values are logged with at most two-digit precision. </p> <p> The format of the "delays=a/b/c/d" logging is as follows: </p> <ul> <li> a = time from message arrival to last <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#active_queue">active queue</a> entry <li> b = time from last <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#active_queue">active queue</a> entry to connection setup <li> c = time in connection setup, including DNS, EHLO and TLS <li> d = time in message transmission </ul> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="delay_notice_recipient">delay_notice_recipient</a> (default: postmaster)</b></DT><DD> <p> The recipient of postmaster notifications with the message headers of mail that cannot be delivered within $<a href="postconf.5.html#delay_warning_time">delay_warning_time</a> time units. </p> <p> This feature is enabled with the <a href="postconf.5.html#delay_warning_time">delay_warning_time</a> parameter. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="delay_warning_time">delay_warning_time</a> (default: 0h)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which the sender receives the message headers of mail that is still queued. </p> <p> To enable this feature, specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the time unit). </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is h (hours). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="deliver_lock_attempts">deliver_lock_attempts</a> (default: 20)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of attempts to acquire an exclusive lock on a mailbox file or <a href="bounce.8.html">bounce(8)</a> logfile. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="deliver_lock_delay">deliver_lock_delay</a> (default: 1s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time between attempts to acquire an exclusive lock on a mailbox file or <a href="bounce.8.html">bounce(8)</a> logfile. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="disable_dns_lookups">disable_dns_lookups</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Disable DNS lookups in the Postfix SMTP and LMTP clients. When disabled, hosts are looked up with the getaddrinfo() system library routine which normally also looks in /etc/hosts. </p> <p> DNS lookups are enabled by default. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="disable_mime_input_processing">disable_mime_input_processing</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Turn off MIME processing while receiving mail. This means that no special treatment is given to Content-Type: message headers, and that all text after the initial message headers is considered to be part of the message body. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> <p> Mime input processing is enabled by default, and is needed in order to recognize MIME headers in message content. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="disable_mime_output_conversion">disable_mime_output_conversion</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Disable the conversion of 8BITMIME format to 7BIT format. Mime output conversion is needed when the destination does not advertise 8BITMIME support. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="disable_verp_bounces">disable_verp_bounces</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Disable sending one bounce report per recipient. </p> <p> The default, one per recipient, is what ezmlm needs. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="disable_vrfy_command">disable_vrfy_command</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Disable the SMTP VRFY command. This stops some techniques used to harvest email addresses. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#disable_vrfy_command">disable_vrfy_command</a> = no </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="dont_remove">dont_remove</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> Don't remove queue files and save them to the "saved" mail queue. This is a debugging aid. To inspect the envelope information and content of a Postfix queue file, use the <a href="postcat.1.html">postcat(1)</a> command. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="double_bounce_sender">double_bounce_sender</a> (default: double-bounce)</b></DT><DD> <p> The sender address of postmaster notifications that are generated by the mail system. All mail to this address is silently discarded, in order to terminate mail bounce loops. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="duplicate_filter_limit">duplicate_filter_limit</a> (default: 1000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of addresses remembered by the address duplicate filter for <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> or <a href="virtual.5.html">virtual(5)</a> alias expansion, or for <a href="showq.8.html">showq(8)</a> queue displays. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="empty_address_recipient">empty_address_recipient</a> (default: MAILER-DAEMON)</b></DT><DD> <p> The recipient of mail addressed to the null address. Postfix does not accept such addresses in SMTP commands, but they may still be created locally as the result of configuration or software error. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="enable_errors_to">enable_errors_to</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Report mail delivery errors to the address specified with the non-standard Errors-To: message header, instead of the envelope sender address (this feature is removed with Postfix version 2.2, is turned off by default with Postfix version 2.1, and is always turned on with older Postfix versions). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="enable_original_recipient">enable_original_recipient</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable support for the X-Original-To message header. This header is needed for multi-recipient mailboxes. </p> <p> When this parameter is set to yes, the <a href="cleanup.8.html">cleanup(8)</a> daemon performs duplicate elimination on distinct pairs of (original recipient, rewritten recipient), and generates non-empty original recipient queue file records. </p> <p> When this parameter is set to no, the <a href="cleanup.8.html">cleanup(8)</a> daemon performs duplicate elimination on the rewritten recipient address only, and generates empty original recipient queue file records. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. With Postfix version 2.0, support for the X-Original-To message header is always turned on. Postfix versions before 2.0 have no support for the X-Original-To message header. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="error_notice_recipient">error_notice_recipient</a> (default: postmaster)</b></DT><DD> <p> The recipient of postmaster notifications about mail delivery problems that are caused by policy, resource, software or protocol errors. These notifications are enabled with the <a href="postconf.5.html#notify_classes">notify_classes</a> parameter. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="error_service_name">error_service_name</a> (default: error)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="error.8.html">error(8)</a> pseudo delivery agent. This service always returns mail as undeliverable. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="execution_directory_expansion_filter">execution_directory_expansion_filter</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> Restrict the characters that the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent allows in $name expansions of $<a href="postconf.5.html#command_execution_directory">command_execution_directory</a>. Characters outside the allowed set are replaced by underscores. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="expand_owner_alias">expand_owner_alias</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> When delivering to an alias "aliasname" that has an "owner-aliasname" companion alias, set the envelope sender address to the expansion of the "owner-aliasname" alias. Normally, Postfix sets the envelope sender address to the name of the "owner-aliasname" alias. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="export_environment">export_environment</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The list of environment variables that a Postfix process will export to non-Postfix processes. The TZ variable is needed for sane time keeping on System-V-ish systems. </p> <p> Specify a list of names and/or name=value pairs, separated by whitespace or comma. The name=value form is supported with Postfix version 2.1 and later. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#export_environment">export_environment</a> = TZ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="extract_recipient_limit">extract_recipient_limit</a> (default: 10240)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipient addresses that Postfix will extract from message headers when mail is submitted with "<b>sendmail -t</b>". </p> <p> This feature was removed in Postfix version 2.1. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fallback_relay">fallback_relay</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional list of relay hosts for SMTP destinations that can't be found or that are unreachable. With Postfix 2.3 this parameter is renamed to <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_fallback_relay">smtp_fallback_relay</a>. </p> <p> By default, mail is returned to the sender when a destination is not found, and delivery is deferred when a destination is unreachable. </p> <p> The fallback relays must be SMTP destinations. Specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port, [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups. If you specify multiple SMTP destinations, Postfix will try them in the specified order. </p> <p> Note: before Postfix 2.2, do not use the <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_relay">fallback_relay</a> feature when relaying mail for a backup or primary MX domain. Mail would loop between the Postfix MX host and the <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_relay">fallback_relay</a> host when the final destination is unavailable. </p> <ul> <li> In <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a> = relay", <li> In <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> specify "-o <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_relay">fallback_relay</a> =" (i.e., empty) at the end of the <tt>relay</tt> entry. <li> In transport maps, specify "relay:<i>nexthop...</i>" as the right-hand side for backup or primary MX domain entries. </ul> <p> Postfix version 2.2 and later will not use the <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_relay">fallback_relay</a> feature for destinations that it is MX host for. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional message delivery transport that the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent should use for names that are not found in the <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> or UNIX password database. </p> <p> The precedence of <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery features from high to low is: aliases, .forward files, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport_maps">mailbox_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command_maps">mailbox_command_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport_maps">fallback_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fallback_transport_maps">fallback_transport_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with per-recipient message delivery transports for recipients that the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent could not find in the <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> or UNIX password database. </p> <p> The precedence of <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery features from high to low is: aliases, .forward files, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport_maps">mailbox_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command_maps">mailbox_command_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport_maps">fallback_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>. </p> <p> For safety reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions in regular expression maps. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fast_flush_domains">fast_flush_domains</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional list of destinations that are eligible for per-destination logfiles with mail that is queued to those destinations. </p> <p> By default, Postfix maintains "fast flush" logfiles only for destinations that the Postfix SMTP server is willing to relay to (i.e. the default is: "<a href="postconf.5.html#fast_flush_domains">fast_flush_domains</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a>"; see the <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a> parameter in the <a href="postconf.5.html">postconf(5)</a> manual). </p> <p> Specify a list of hosts or domains, "/file/name" patterns or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when the domain or its parent domain appears as lookup key. </p> <p> Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#fast_flush_domains">fast_flush_domains</a> =" (i.e., empty) to disable the feature altogether. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fast_flush_purge_time">fast_flush_purge_time</a> (default: 7d)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which an empty per-destination "fast flush" logfile is deleted. </p> <p> You can specify the time as a number, or as a number followed by a letter that indicates the time unit: s=seconds, m=minutes, h=hours, d=days, w=weeks. The default time unit is days. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fast_flush_refresh_time">fast_flush_refresh_time</a> (default: 12h)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which a non-empty but unread per-destination "fast flush" logfile needs to be refreshed. The contents of a logfile are refreshed by requesting delivery of all messages listed in the logfile. </p> <p> You can specify the time as a number, or as a number followed by a letter that indicates the time unit: s=seconds, m=minutes, h=hours, d=days, w=weeks. The default time unit is hours. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fault_injection_code">fault_injection_code</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> Force specific internal tests to fail, to test the handling of errors that are difficult to reproduce otherwise. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="flush_service_name">flush_service_name</a> (default: flush)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="flush.8.html">flush(8)</a> service. This service maintains per-destination logfiles with the queue file names of mail that is queued for those destinations. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fork_attempts">fork_attempts</a> (default: 5)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of attempts to fork() a child process. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="fork_delay">fork_delay</a> (default: 1s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The delay between attempts to fork() a child process. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="forward_expansion_filter">forward_expansion_filter</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> Restrict the characters that the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent allows in $name expansions of $<a href="postconf.5.html#forward_path">forward_path</a>. Characters outside the allowed set are replaced by underscores. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="forward_path">forward_path</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent search list for finding a .forward file with user-specified delivery methods. The first file that is found is used. </p> <p> The following $name expansions are done on <a href="postconf.5.html#forward_path">forward_path</a> before the search actually happens. The result of $name expansion is filtered with the character set that is specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#forward_expansion_filter">forward_expansion_filter</a> parameter. </p> <dl> <dt><b>$user</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's username. </dd> <dt><b>$shell</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's login shell pathname. </dd> <dt><b>$home</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's home directory. </dd> <dt><b>$recipient</b></dt> <dd>The full recipient address. </dd> <dt><b>$extension</b></dt> <dd>The optional recipient address extension. </dd> <dt><b>$domain</b></dt> <dd>The recipient domain. </dd> <dt><b>$local</b></dt> <dd>The entire recipient localpart. </dd> <dt><b>$<a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_delimiter">recipient_delimiter</a></b></dt> <dd>The system-wide recipient address extension delimiter. </dd> <dt><b>${name?value}</b></dt> <dd>Expands to <i>value</i> when <i>$name</i> is non-empty. </dd> <dt><b>${name:value}</b></dt> <dd>Expands to <i>value</i> when <i>$name</i> is empty. </dd> </dl> <p> Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name). </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#forward_path">forward_path</a> = /var/forward/$user <a href="postconf.5.html#forward_path">forward_path</a> = /var/forward/$user/.forward$<a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_delimiter">recipient_delimiter</a>$extension, /var/forward/$user/.forward </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="frozen_delivered_to">frozen_delivered_to</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Update the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent's idea of the Delivered-To: address (see <a href="postconf.5.html#prepend_delivered_header">prepend_delivered_header</a>) only once, at the start of a delivery attempt; do not update the Delivered-To: address while expanding aliases or .forward files. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. With older Postfix releases, the behavior is as if this parameter is set to "no". The old setting can be expensive with deeply nested aliases or .forward files. When an alias or .forward file changes the Delivered-To: address, it ties up one queue file and one cleanup process instance while mail is being forwarded. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="hash_queue_depth">hash_queue_depth</a> (default: 1)</b></DT><DD> <p> The number of subdirectory levels for queue directories listed with the <a href="postconf.5.html#hash_queue_names">hash_queue_names</a> parameter. </p> <p> After changing the <a href="postconf.5.html#hash_queue_names">hash_queue_names</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#hash_queue_depth">hash_queue_depth</a> parameter, execute the command "<b>postfix reload</b>". </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="hash_queue_names">hash_queue_names</a> (default: deferred, defer)</b></DT><DD> <p> The names of queue directories that are split across multiple subdirectory levels. </p> <p> Before Postfix version 2.2, the default list of hashed queues was significantly larger. Claims about improvements in file system technology suggest that hashing of the <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#incoming_queue">incoming</a> and <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#active_queue">active queues</a> is no longer needed. Fewer hashed directories speed up the time needed to restart Postfix. </p> <p> After changing the <a href="postconf.5.html#hash_queue_names">hash_queue_names</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#hash_queue_depth">hash_queue_depth</a> parameter, execute the command "<b>postfix reload</b>". </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="header_address_token_limit">header_address_token_limit</a> (default: 10240)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of address tokens are allowed in an address message header. Information that exceeds the limit is discarded. The limit is enforced by the <a href="cleanup.8.html">cleanup(8)</a> server. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="header_checks">header_checks</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables for content inspection of primary non-MIME message headers, as specified in the <a href="header_checks.5.html">header_checks(5)</a> manual page. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="header_size_limit">header_size_limit</a> (default: 102400)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal amount of memory in bytes for storing a message header. If a header is larger, the excess is discarded. The limit is enforced by the <a href="cleanup.8.html">cleanup(8)</a> server. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="helpful_warnings">helpful_warnings</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Log warnings about problematic configuration settings, and provide helpful suggestions. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional pathname of a mailbox file relative to a <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> user's home directory. </p> <p> Specify a pathname ending in "/" for qmail-style delivery. </p> <p> The precedence of <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery features from high to low is: aliases, .forward files, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport_maps">mailbox_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command_maps">mailbox_command_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport_maps">fallback_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a> = Mailbox <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a> = Maildir/ </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="hopcount_limit">hopcount_limit</a> (default: 50)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of Received: message headers that is allowed in the primary message headers. A message that exceeds the limit is bounced, in order to stop a mailer loop. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="html_directory">html_directory</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The location of Postfix HTML files that describe how to build, configure or operate a specific Postfix subsystem or feature. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="ignore_mx_lookup_error">ignore_mx_lookup_error</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Ignore DNS MX lookups that produce no response. By default, the Postfix SMTP client defers delivery and tries again after some delay. This behavior is required by the SMTP standard. </p> <p> Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#ignore_mx_lookup_error">ignore_mx_lookup_error</a> = yes" to force a DNS A record lookup instead. This violates the SMTP standard and can result in mis-delivery of mail. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="import_environment">import_environment</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The list of environment parameters that a Postfix process will import from a non-Postfix parent process. Examples of relevant parameters: </p> <dl> <dt><b>TZ</b></dt> <dd>Needed for sane time keeping on most System-V-ish systems. </dd> <dt><b>DISPLAY</b></dt> <dd>Needed for debugging Postfix daemons with an X-windows debugger. </dd> <dt><b>XAUTHORITY</b></dt> <dd>Needed for debugging Postfix daemons with an X-windows debugger. </dd> <dt><b>MAIL_CONFIG</b></dt> <dd>Needed to make "<b>postfix -c</b>" work. </dd> </dl> <p> Specify a list of names and/or name=value pairs, separated by whitespace or comma. The name=value form is supported with Postfix version 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="in_flow_delay">in_flow_delay</a> (default: 1s)</b></DT><DD> <p> Time to pause before accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the message delivery rate. This feature is turned on by default (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due to an SCO bug). </p> <p> With the default 100 SMTP server process limit, "<a href="postconf.5.html#in_flow_delay">in_flow_delay</a> = 1s" limits the mail inflow to 100 messages per second above the number of messages delivered per second. </p> <p> Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> (default: all)</b></DT><DD> <p> The network interface addresses that this mail system receives mail on. Specify "all" to receive mail on all network interfaces (default), and "loopback-only" to receive mail on loopback network interfaces only (Postfix version 2.2 and later). The parameter also controls delivery of mail to <tt>user@[ip.address]</tt>. </p> <p> Note 1: you need to stop and start Postfix when this parameter changes. </p> <p> Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside <tt>[]</tt>, but this form is not required here. </p> <p> When <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> specifies just one IPv4 and/or IPv6 address that is not a loopback address, the Postfix SMTP client will use this address as the IP source address for outbound mail. Support for IPv6 is available in Postfix version 2.2 and later. </p> <p> On a multi-homed firewall with separate Postfix instances listening on the "inside" and "outside" interfaces, this can prevent each instance from being able to reach servers on the "other side" of the firewall. Setting <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_bind_address">smtp_bind_address</a> to 0.0.0.0 avoids the potential problem for IPv4, and setting <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_bind_address6">smtp_bind_address6</a> to :: solves the problem for IPv6. </p> <p> A better solution for multi-homed firewalls is to leave <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> at the default value and instead use explicit IP addresses in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> SMTP server definitions. This preserves the Postfix SMTP client's loop detection, by ensuring that each side of the firewall knows that the other IP address is still the same host. Setting $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> to a single IPv4 and/or IPV6 address is primarily useful with virtual hosting of domains on secondary IP addresses, when each IP address serves a different domain (and has a different $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> setting). </p> <p> See also the <a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a> parameter, for network addresses that are forwarded to Postfix by way of a proxy or address translator. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> = all (DEFAULT) <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> = loopback-only (Postfix version 2.2 and later) <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> = 127.0.0.1 <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> = 127.0.0.1, [::1] (Postfix version 2.2 and later) <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> = 192.168.1.2, 127.0.0.1 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="inet_protocols">inet_protocols</a> (default: ipv4)</b></DT><DD> <p> The Internet protocols Postfix will attempt to use when making or accepting connections. Specify one or more of "ipv4" or "ipv6", separated by whitespace or commas. The form "all" is equivalent to "ipv4, ipv6" or "ipv4", depending on whether the operating system implements IPv6. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> Note: you MUST stop and start Postfix after changing this parameter. </p> <p> On systems that pre-date IPV6_V6ONLY support (<a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc3493.html">RFC 3493</a>), an IPv6 server will also accept IPv4 connections, even when IPv4 is turned off with the <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_protocols">inet_protocols</a> parameter. On systems with IPV6_V6ONLY support, Postfix will use separate server sockets for IPv6 and IPv4, and each will accept only connections for the corresponding protocol. </p> <p> When IPv4 support is enabled via the <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_protocols">inet_protocols</a> parameter, Postfix will to DNS type A record lookups, and will convert IPv4-in-IPv6 client IP addresses (::ffff:1.2.3.4) to their original IPv4 form (1.2.3.4). The latter is needed on hosts that pre-date IPV6_V6ONLY support (<a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc3493.html">RFC 3493</a>). </p> <p> When IPv6 support is enabled via the <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_protocols">inet_protocols</a> parameter, Postfix will do DNS type AAAA record lookups. </p> <p> When both IPv4 and IPv6 support are enabled, the Postfix SMTP client will attempt to connect via IPv6 before attempting to use IPv4. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_protocols">inet_protocols</a> = ipv4 (DEFAULT) <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_protocols">inet_protocols</a> = all <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_protocols">inet_protocols</a> = ipv6 <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_protocols">inet_protocols</a> = ipv4, ipv6 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="initial_destination_concurrency">initial_destination_concurrency</a> (default: 5)</b></DT><DD> <p> The initial per-destination concurrency level for parallel delivery to the same destination. This limit applies to delivery via <a href="smtp.8.html">smtp(8)</a>, and via the <a href="pipe.8.html">pipe(8)</a> and <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agents. </p> <p> Warning: with concurrency of 1, one bad message can be enough to block all mail to a site. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="internal_mail_filter_classes">internal_mail_filter_classes</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> What categories of Postfix-generated mail are subject to before-queue content inspection by <a href="postconf.5.html#non_smtpd_milters">non_smtpd_milters</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#header_checks">header_checks</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#body_checks">body_checks</a>. Specify zero or more of the following, separated by whitespace or comma. </p> <dl> <dt><b>bounce</b></dt> <dd> Inspect the content of delivery status notifications. </dd> <dt><b>notify</b></dt> <dd> Inspect the content of postmaster notifications by the <a href="smtp.8.html">smtp(8)</a> and <a href="smtpd.8.html">smtpd(8)</a> processes. </dd> </dl> <p> NOTE: It's generally not safe to enable content inspection of Postfix-generated email messages. The user is warned. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="invalid_hostname_reject_code">invalid_hostname_reject_code</a> (default: 501)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when the client HELO or EHLO command parameter is rejected by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_invalid_helo_hostname">reject_invalid_helo_hostname</a> restriction. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="ipc_idle">ipc_idle</a> (default: version dependent)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which a client closes an idle internal communication channel. The purpose is to allow servers to terminate voluntarily after they become idle. This is used, for example, by the address resolving and rewriting clients. </p> <p> With Postfix 2.4 the default value was reduced from 100s to 5s. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="ipc_timeout">ipc_timeout</a> (default: 3600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for sending or receiving information over an internal communication channel. The purpose is to break out of deadlock situations. If the time limit is exceeded the software aborts with a fatal error. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="ipc_ttl">ipc_ttl</a> (default: 1000s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which a client closes an active internal communication channel. The purpose is to allow servers to terminate voluntarily after reaching their client limit. This is used, for example, by the address resolving and rewriting clients. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="line_length_limit">line_length_limit</a> (default: 2048)</b></DT><DD> <p> Upon input, long lines are chopped up into pieces of at most this length; upon delivery, long lines are reconstructed. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_bind_address">lmtp_bind_address</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_bind_address">smtp_bind_address</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_bind_address6">lmtp_bind_address6</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_bind_address6">smtp_bind_address6</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_cache_connection">lmtp_cache_connection</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Keep Postfix LMTP client connections open for up to $<a href="postconf.5.html#max_idle">max_idle</a> seconds. When the LMTP client receives a request for the same connection the connection is reused. </p> <p> The effectiveness of cached connections will be determined by the number of LMTP servers in use, and the concurrency limit specified for the LMTP client. Cached connections are closed under any of the following conditions: </p> <ul> <li> The LMTP client idle time limit is reached. This limit is specified with the Postfix <a href="postconf.5.html#max_idle">max_idle</a> configuration parameter. <li> A delivery request specifies a different destination than the one currently cached. <li> The per-process limit on the number of delivery requests is reached. This limit is specified with the Postfix <a href="postconf.5.html#max_use">max_use</a> configuration parameter. <li> Upon the onset of another delivery request, the LMTP server associated with the current session does not respond to the RSET command. </ul> <p> Most of these limitations will be removed after Postfix implements a connection cache that is shared among multiple LMTP client programs. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_cname_overrides_servername">lmtp_cname_overrides_servername</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_cname_overrides_servername">smtp_cname_overrides_servername</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_connect_timeout">lmtp_connect_timeout</a> (default: 0s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for completing a TCP connection, or zero (use the operating system built-in time limit). When no connection can be made within the deadline, the LMTP client tries the next address on the mail exchanger list. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_connect_timeout">lmtp_connect_timeout</a> = 30s </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_connection_cache_destinations">lmtp_connection_cache_destinations</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_connection_cache_destinations">smtp_connection_cache_destinations</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_connection_cache_on_demand">lmtp_connection_cache_on_demand</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_connection_cache_on_demand">smtp_connection_cache_on_demand</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_connection_cache_time_limit">lmtp_connection_cache_time_limit</a> (default: 2s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_connection_cache_time_limit">smtp_connection_cache_time_limit</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_connection_reuse_time_limit">lmtp_connection_reuse_time_limit</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit">smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_data_done_timeout">lmtp_data_done_timeout</a> (default: 600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the LMTP ".", and for receiving the server response. When no response is received within the deadline, a warning is logged that the mail may be delivered multiple times. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_data_init_timeout">lmtp_data_init_timeout</a> (default: 120s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the LMTP DATA command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_data_xfer_timeout">lmtp_data_xfer_timeout</a> (default: 180s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the LMTP message content. When the connection stalls for more than $<a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_data_xfer_timeout">lmtp_data_xfer_timeout</a> the LMTP client terminates the transfer. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found">lmtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found">smtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_destination_concurrency_limit">lmtp_destination_concurrency_limit</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_destination_concurrency_limit">default_destination_concurrency_limit</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same destination via the lmtp message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_destination_recipient_limit">lmtp_destination_recipient_limit</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_destination_recipient_limit">default_destination_recipient_limit</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipients per delivery via the lmtp message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> <p> Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the meaning of <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_destination_concurrency_limit">lmtp_destination_concurrency_limit</a> from concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_discard_lhlo_keyword_address_maps">lmtp_discard_lhlo_keyword_address_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Lookup tables, indexed by the remote LMTP server address, with case insensitive lists of LHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the LMTP client will ignore in the LHLO response from a remote LMTP server. See <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_discard_lhlo_keywords">lmtp_discard_lhlo_keywords</a> for details. The table is not indexed by hostname for consistency with <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps">smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps</a>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_discard_lhlo_keywords">lmtp_discard_lhlo_keywords</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> A case insensitive list of LHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the LMTP client will ignore in the LHLO response from a remote LMTP server. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> <p> Notes: </p> <ul> <li> <p> Specify the <b>silent-discard</b> pseudo keyword to prevent this action from being logged. </p> <li> <p> Use the <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_discard_lhlo_keyword_address_maps">lmtp_discard_lhlo_keyword_address_maps</a> feature to discard LHLO keywords selectively. </p> </ul> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_enforce_tls">lmtp_enforce_tls</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_enforce_tls">smtp_enforce_tls</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_generic_maps">lmtp_generic_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_generic_maps">smtp_generic_maps</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_host_lookup">lmtp_host_lookup</a> (default: dns)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_host_lookup">smtp_host_lookup</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_lhlo_name">lmtp_lhlo_name</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The hostname to send in the LMTP LHLO command. </p> <p> The default value is the machine hostname. Specify a hostname or [ip.add.re.ss]. </p> <p> This information can be specified in the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> file for all LMTP clients, or it can be specified in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file for a specific client, for example: </p> <pre> /etc/postfix/<a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>: mylmtp ... lmtp -o <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_lhloname">lmtp_lhlo_name</a>=foo.bar.com </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_lhlo_timeout">lmtp_lhlo_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the LHLO command, and for receiving the initial server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_line_length_limit">lmtp_line_length_limit</a> (default: 990)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_line_length_limit">smtp_line_length_limit</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_mail_timeout">lmtp_mail_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the MAIL FROM command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_mx_address_limit">lmtp_mx_address_limit</a> (default: 5)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_mx_address_limit">smtp_mx_address_limit</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_mx_session_limit">lmtp_mx_session_limit</a> (default: 2)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_mx_session_limit">smtp_mx_session_limit</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_pix_workaround_delay_time">lmtp_pix_workaround_delay_time</a> (default: 10s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time">smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_pix_workaround_maps">lmtp_pix_workaround_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_pix_workaround_maps">smtp_pix_workaround_maps</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time">lmtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time</a> (default: 500s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time">smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_pix_workarounds">lmtp_pix_workarounds</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_pix_workaround configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_quit_timeout">lmtp_quit_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the QUIT command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_quote_rfc821_envelope">lmtp_quote_rfc821_envelope</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope">smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_randomize_addresses">lmtp_randomize_addresses</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_randomize_addresses">smtp_randomize_addresses</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_rcpt_timeout">lmtp_rcpt_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the RCPT TO command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_rset_timeout">lmtp_rset_timeout</a> (default: 20s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the RSET command, and for receiving the server response. The LMTP client sends RSET in order to finish a recipient address probe, or to verify that a cached connection is still alive. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sasl_auth_enable">lmtp_sasl_auth_enable</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable SASL authentication in the Postfix LMTP client. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sasl_mechanism_filter">lmtp_sasl_mechanism_filter</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter">smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sasl_password_maps">lmtp_sasl_password_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional LMTP client lookup tables with one username:password entry per host or domain. If a remote host or domain has no username:password entry, then the Postfix LMTP client will not attempt to authenticate to the remote host. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sasl_path">lmtp_sasl_path</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Implementation-specific information that is passed through to the SASL plug-in implementation that is selected with <b><a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_sasl_type">lmtp_sasl_type</a></b>. Typically this specifies the name of a configuration file or rendezvous point. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sasl_security_options">lmtp_sasl_security_options</a> (default: noplaintext, noanonymous)</b></DT><DD> <p> SASL security options; as of Postfix 2.3 the list of available features depends on the SASL client implementation that is selected with <b><a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_sasl_type">lmtp_sasl_type</a></b>. </p> <p> The following security features are defined for the <b>cyrus</b> client SASL implementation: </p> <dl> <dt><b>noplaintext</b></dt> <dd>Disallow authentication methods that use plaintext passwords. </dd> <dt><b>noactive</b></dt> <dd>Disallow authentication methods that are vulnerable to non-dictionary active attacks. </dd> <dt><b>nodictionary</b></dt> <dd>Disallow authentication methods that are vulnerable to passive dictionary attack. </dd> <dt><b>noanonymous</b></dt> <dd>Disallow anonymous logins. </dd> </dl> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_sasl_security_options">lmtp_sasl_security_options</a> = noplaintext </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sasl_tls_security_options">lmtp_sasl_tls_security_options</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_sasl_security_options">lmtp_sasl_security_options</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_tls_security_options">smtp_sasl_tls_security_options</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options">lmtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_sasl_tls_security_options">lmtp_sasl_tls_security_options</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options">smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sasl_type">lmtp_sasl_type</a> (default: cyrus)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SASL plug-in type that the Postfix LMTP client should use for authentication. The available types are listed with the "<b>postconf -A</b>" command. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_send_xforward_command">lmtp_send_xforward_command</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Send an XFORWARD command to the LMTP server when the LMTP LHLO server response announces XFORWARD support. This allows an <a href="lmtp.8.html">lmtp(8)</a> delivery agent, used for content filter message injection, to forward the name, address, protocol and HELO name of the original client to the content filter and downstream queuing LMTP server. Before you change the value to yes, it is best to make sure that your content filter supports this command. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_sender_dependent_authentication">lmtp_sender_dependent_authentication</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sender_dependent_authentication">smtp_sender_dependent_authentication</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_skip_5xx_greeting">lmtp_skip_5xx_greeting</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_skip_5xx_greeting">smtp_skip_5xx_greeting</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_skip_quit_response">lmtp_skip_quit_response</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Wait for the response to the LMTP QUIT command. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_starttls_timeout">lmtp_starttls_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_starttls_timeout">smtp_starttls_timeout</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tcp_port">lmtp_tcp_port</a> (default: 24)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default TCP port that the Postfix LMTP client connects to. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_CAfile">lmtp_tls_CAfile</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_CAfile">smtp_tls_CAfile</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_CApath">lmtp_tls_CApath</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_CApath">smtp_tls_CApath</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_cert_file">lmtp_tls_cert_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_dcert_file">lmtp_tls_dcert_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_dcert_file">smtp_tls_dcert_file</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_dkey_file">lmtp_tls_dkey_file</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_tls_dcert_file">lmtp_tls_dcert_file</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_dkey_file">smtp_tls_dkey_file</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_enforce_peername">lmtp_tls_enforce_peername</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_enforce_peername">smtp_tls_enforce_peername</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">lmtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_key_file">lmtp_tls_key_file</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_tls_cert_file">lmtp_tls_cert_file</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_key_file">smtp_tls_key_file</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_loglevel">lmtp_tls_loglevel</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_loglevel">smtp_tls_loglevel</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">lmtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">lmtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> (default: SSLv3, TLSv1)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_note_starttls_offer">lmtp_tls_note_starttls_offer</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer">smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_per_site">lmtp_tls_per_site</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_per_site">smtp_tls_per_site</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_policy_maps">lmtp_tls_policy_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_scert_verifydepth">lmtp_tls_scert_verifydepth</a> (default: 5)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth">smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_secure_cert_match">lmtp_tls_secure_cert_match</a> (default: nexthop)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_secure_cert_match">smtp_tls_secure_cert_match</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_session_cache_database">lmtp_tls_session_cache_database</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_session_cache_database">smtp_tls_session_cache_database</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_session_cache_timeout">lmtp_tls_session_cache_timeout</a> (default: 3600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout">smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_tls_verify_cert_match">lmtp_tls_verify_cert_match</a> (default: hostname)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_verify_cert_match">smtp_tls_verify_cert_match</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_use_tls">lmtp_use_tls</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP-specific version of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_use_tls">smtp_use_tls</a> configuration parameter. See there for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="lmtp_xforward_timeout">lmtp_xforward_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The LMTP client time limit for sending the XFORWARD command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> In case of problems the client does NOT try the next address on the mail exchanger list. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="local_command_shell">local_command_shell</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional shell program for <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery to non-Postfix command. By default, non-Postfix commands are executed directly; commands are given to given to /bin/sh only when they contain shell meta characters or shell built-in commands. </p> <p> "sendmail's restricted shell" (smrsh) is what most people will use in order to restrict what programs can be run from e.g. .forward files (smrsh is part of the Sendmail distribution). </p> <p> Note: when a shell program is specified, it is invoked even when the command contains no shell built-in commands or meta characters. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#local_command_shell">local_command_shell</a> = /some/where/smrsh -c </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="local_destination_concurrency_limit">local_destination_concurrency_limit</a> (default: 2)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of parallel deliveries via the local mail delivery transport to the same recipient (when "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_destination_recipient_limit">local_destination_recipient_limit</a> = 1") or the maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html#local_domain_class">local domain</a> (when "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_destination_recipient_limit">local_destination_recipient_limit</a> > 1"). This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> <p> A low limit of 2 is recommended, just in case someone has an expensive shell command in a .forward file or in an alias (e.g., a mailing list manager). You don't want to run lots of those at the same time. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="local_destination_recipient_limit">local_destination_recipient_limit</a> (default: 1)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipients per message delivery via the local mail delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> <p> Setting this parameter to a value > 1 changes the meaning of <a href="postconf.5.html#local_destination_concurrency_limit">local_destination_concurrency_limit</a> from concurrency per recipient into concurrency per domain. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> (default: <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_inet_interfaces">permit_inet_interfaces</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Rewrite message header addresses in mail from these clients and update incomplete addresses with the domain name in $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a>; either don't rewrite message headers from other clients at all, or rewrite message headers and update incomplete addresses with the domain specified in the <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> parameter. </p> <p> See the <a href="postconf.5.html#append_at_myorigin">append_at_myorigin</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#append_dot_mydomain">append_dot_mydomain</a> parameters for details of how domain names are appended to incomplete addresses. </p> <p> Specify a list of zero or more of the following: </p> <dl> <dt><b><a href="postconf.5.html#permit_inet_interfaces">permit_inet_interfaces</a></b></dt> <dd> Append the domain name in $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> when the client IP address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a>. This is enabled by default. </dd> <dt><b><a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a></b></dt> <dd> Append the domain name in $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> when the client IP address matches any network or network address listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a>. This setting will not prevent remote mail header address rewriting when mail from a remote client is forwarded by a neighboring system. </dd> <dt><b> <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_sasl_authenticated">permit_sasl_authenticated</a> </b></dt> <dd> Append the domain name in $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> when the client is successfully authenticated via the <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc2554.html">RFC 2554</a> (AUTH) protocol. </dd> <dt><b> <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_tls_clientcerts">permit_tls_clientcerts</a> </b></dt> <dd> Append the domain name in $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> when the client TLS certificate is successfully verified, and the client certificate fingerprint is listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_clientcerts">relay_clientcerts</a>. </dd> <dt><b> <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_tls_all_clientcerts">permit_tls_all_clientcerts</a> </b></dt> <dd> Append the domain name in $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> when the client TLS certificate is successfully verified, regardless of whether it is listed on the server, and regardless of the certifying authority. </dd> <dt><b> <a name="check_address_map">check_address_map</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i> </b></dt> <dt><b> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i> </b></dt> <dd> Append the domain name in $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> when the client IP address matches the specified lookup table. The lookup result is ignored, and no subnet lookup is done. This is suitable for, e.g., pop-before-smtp lookup tables. </dd> </dl> <p> Examples: </p> <p> The Postfix < 2.2 backwards compatible setting: always rewrite message headers, and always append my own domain to incomplete header addresses. </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = static:all </pre> <p> The purist (and default) setting: rewrite headers only in mail from Postfix sendmail and in SMTP mail from this machine. </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_inet_interfaces">permit_inet_interfaces</a> </pre> <p> The intermediate setting: rewrite header addresses and append $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> information only with mail from Postfix sendmail, from local clients, or from authorized SMTP clients. </p> <p> Note: this setting will not prevent remote mail header address rewriting when mail from a remote client is forwarded by a neighboring system. </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_sasl_authenticated">permit_sasl_authenticated</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_tls_clientcerts">permit_tls_clientcerts</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#check_address_map">check_address_map</a> hash:/etc/postfix/pop-before-smtp </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> (default: <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxy</a>:unix:passwd.byname $<a href="postconf.5.html#alias_maps">alias_maps</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Lookup tables with all names or addresses of local recipients: a recipient address is local when its domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>. Specify @domain as a wild-card for domains that do not have a valid recipient list. Technically, tables listed with $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> are used as lists: Postfix needs to know only if a lookup string is found or not, but it does not use the result from table lookup. </p> <p> If this parameter is non-empty (the default), then the Postfix SMTP server will reject mail for unknown local users. </p> <p> To turn off local recipient checking in the Postfix SMTP server, specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> =" (i.e. empty). </p> <p> The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the <a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> setting if: </p> <ul> <li>You redefine the local delivery agent in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>. <li>You redefine the "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_transport">local_transport</a>" setting in <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a>. <li>You use the "<a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>", "<a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a>", or "<a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a>" feature of the Postfix <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent. </ul> <p> Details are described in the <a href="LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README.html">LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README</a> file. </p> <p> Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you need to access the passwd file via the <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxymap(8)</a> service, in order to overcome chroot access restrictions. The alternative, maintaining a copy of the system password file in the chroot jail is not practical. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> = </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="local_transport">local_transport</a> (default: <a href="local.8.html">local</a>:$<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for final delivery to domains listed with <a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, and for [ipaddress] destinations that match $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>. This information can be overruled with the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. </p> <p> By default, local mail is delivered to the transport called "local", which is just the name of a service that is defined the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> <p> Specify a string of the form <i>transport:nexthop</i>, where <i>transport</i> is the name of a mail delivery transport defined in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>. The <i>:nexthop</i> part is optional. For more details see the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> manual page. </p> <p> Beware: if you override the default local delivery agent then you need to review the <a href="LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README.html">LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README</a> document, otherwise the SMTP server may reject mail for local recipients. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="luser_relay">luser_relay</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional catch-all destination for unknown <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> recipients. By default, mail for unknown recipients in domains that match $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a> is returned as undeliverable. </p> <p> The following $name expansions are done on <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>: </p> <dl> <dt><b>$domain</b></dt> <dd>The recipient domain. </dd> <dt><b>$extension</b></dt> <dd>The recipient address extension. </dd> <dt><b>$home</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's home directory. </dd> <dt><b>$local</b></dt> <dd>The entire recipient address localpart. </dd> <dt><b>$recipient</b></dt> <dd>The full recipient address. </dd> <dt><b>$<a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_delimiter">recipient_delimiter</a></b></dt> <dd>The system-wide recipient address extension delimiter. </dd> <dt><b>$shell</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's login shell. </dd> <dt><b>$user</b></dt> <dd>The recipient username. </dd> <dt><b>${name?value}</b></dt> <dd>Expands to <i>value</i> when <i>$name</i> has a non-empty value. </dd> <dt><b>${name:value}</b></dt> <dd>Expands to <i>value</i> when <i>$name</i> has an empty value. </dd> </dl> <p> Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name). </p> <p> Note: <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a> works only for the Postfix <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent. </p> <p> Note: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password file, then you must specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> =" (i.e. empty) in the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> file, otherwise the Postfix SMTP server will reject mail for non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table". </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a> = $user@other.host <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a> = $local@other.host <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a> = admin+$local </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mail_name">mail_name</a> (default: Postfix)</b></DT><DD> <p> The mail system name that is displayed in Received: headers, in the SMTP greeting banner, and in bounced mail. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mail_owner">mail_owner</a> (default: postfix)</b></DT><DD> <p> The UNIX system account that owns the Postfix queue and most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user account that does not share a group with other accounts and that owns no other files or processes on the system. In particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED USER ID AND GROUP ID. </p> <p> When this parameter value is changed you need to re-run "<b>postfix set-permissions</b>" (with Postfix version 2.0 and earlier: "<b>/etc/postfix/post-install set-permissions</b>". </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mail_release_date">mail_release_date</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The Postfix release date, in "YYYYMMDD" format. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The directory where <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the system type. Specify a name ending in / for maildir-style delivery. </p> <p> Note: maildir delivery is done with the privileges of the recipient. If you use the <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a> setting for maildir style delivery, then you must create the top-level maildir directory in advance. Postfix will not create it. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a> = /var/mail <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a> = /var/spool/mail </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mail_version">mail_version</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The version of the mail system. Stable releases are named <i>major</i>.<i>minor</i>.<i>patchlevel</i>. Experimental releases also include the release date. The version string can be used in, for example, the SMTP greeting banner. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional external command that the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent should use for mailbox delivery. The command is run with the user ID and the primary group ID privileges of the recipient. Exception: command delivery for root executes with $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_privs">default_privs</a> privileges. This is not a problem, because 1) mail for root should always be aliased to a real user and 2) don't log in as root, use "su" instead. </p> <p> The following environment variables are exported to the command: </p> <dl> <dt><b>CLIENT_ADDRESS</b></dt> <dd>Remote client network address. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later. </dd> <dt><b>CLIENT_HELO</b></dt> <dd>Remote client EHLO command parameter. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.</dd> <dt><b>CLIENT_HOSTNAME</b></dt> <dd>Remote client hostname. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later. </dd> <dt><b>CLIENT_PROTOCOL</b></dt> <dd>Remote client protocol. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later. </dd> <dt><b>DOMAIN</b></dt> <dd>The domain part of the recipient address. </dd> <dt><b>EXTENSION</b></dt> <dd>The optional address extension. </dd> <dt><b>HOME</b></dt> <dd>The recipient home directory. </dd> <dt><b>LOCAL</b></dt> <dd>The recipient address localpart. </dd> <dt><b>LOGNAME</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's username. </dd> <dt><b>RECIPIENT</b></dt> <dd>The full recipient address. </dd> <dt><b>SASL_METHOD</b></dt> <dd>SASL authentication method specified in the remote client AUTH command. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later. </dd> <dt><b>SASL_SENDER</b></dt> <dd>SASL sender address specified in the remote client MAIL FROM command. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later. </dd> <dt><b>SASL_USER</b></dt> <dd>SASL username specified in the remote client AUTH command. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later. </dd> <dt><b>SENDER</b></dt> <dd>The full sender address. </dd> <dt><b>SHELL</b></dt> <dd>The recipient's login shell. </dd> <dt><b>USER</b></dt> <dd>The recipient username. </dd> </dl> <p> Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a> parameter is not subjected to $name substitutions. This is to make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below). </p> <p> If you can, avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run an expensive shell process. If you're delivering via Procmail then running a shell won't make a noticeable difference in the total cost. </p> <p> Note: if you use the <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a> feature to deliver mail system-wide, you must set up an alias that forwards mail for root to a real user. </p> <p> The precedence of <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery features from high to low is: aliases, .forward files, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport_maps">mailbox_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command_maps">mailbox_command_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport_maps">fallback_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a> = /some/where/procmail <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a> = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION" <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a> = /some/where/maildrop -d "$USER" -f "$SENDER" "$EXTENSION" </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mailbox_command_maps">mailbox_command_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with per-recipient external commands to use for <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> mailbox delivery. Behavior is as with <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>. </p> <p> The precedence of <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery features from high to low is: aliases, .forward files, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport_maps">mailbox_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command_maps">mailbox_command_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport_maps">fallback_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mailbox_delivery_lock">mailbox_delivery_lock</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> How to lock a UNIX-style <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> mailbox before attempting delivery. For a list of available file locking methods, use the "<b>postconf -l</b>" command. </p> <p> This setting is ignored with <b>maildir</b> style delivery, because such deliveries are safe without explicit locks. </p> <p> Note: The <b>dotlock</b> method requires that the recipient UID or GID has write access to the parent directory of the mailbox file. </p> <p> Note: the default setting of this parameter is system dependent. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mailbox_size_limit">mailbox_size_limit</a> (default: 51200000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal size of any <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> individual mailbox or maildir file, or zero (no limit). In fact, this limits the size of any file that is written to upon local delivery, including files written by external commands that are executed by the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent. </p> <p> This limit must not be smaller than the message size limit. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional message delivery transport that the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent should use for mailbox delivery to all local recipients, whether or not they are found in the UNIX passwd database. </p> <p> The precedence of <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery features from high to low is: aliases, .forward files, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport_maps">mailbox_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command_maps">mailbox_command_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport_maps">fallback_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mailbox_transport_maps">mailbox_transport_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with per-recipient message delivery transports to use for <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> mailbox delivery, whether or not the recipients are found in the UNIX passwd database. </p> <p> The precedence of <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery features from high to low is: aliases, .forward files, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport_maps">mailbox_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_transport">mailbox_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command_maps">mailbox_command_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_command">mailbox_command</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#home_mailbox">home_mailbox</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#mail_spool_directory">mail_spool_directory</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport_maps">fallback_transport_maps</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_transport">fallback_transport</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#luser_relay">luser_relay</a>. </p> <p> For safety reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions in regular expression maps. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mailq_path">mailq_path</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> Sendmail compatibility feature that specifies where the Postfix <a href="mailq.1.html">mailq(1)</a> command is installed. This command can be used to list the Postfix mail queue. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="manpage_directory">manpage_directory</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> Where the Postfix manual pages are installed. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="maps_rbl_domains">maps_rbl_domains</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Obsolete feature: use the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_rbl_client">reject_rbl_client</a> feature instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="maps_rbl_reject_code">maps_rbl_reject_code</a> (default: 554)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a remote SMTP client request is blocked by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_rbl_client">reject_rbl_client</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_rhsbl_client">reject_rhsbl_client</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_rhsbl_sender">reject_rhsbl_sender</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_rhsbl_recipient">reject_rhsbl_recipient</a> restriction. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="masquerade_classes">masquerade_classes</a> (default: envelope_sender, header_sender, header_recipient)</b></DT><DD> <p> What addresses are subject to address masquerading. </p> <p> By default, address masquerading is limited to envelope sender addresses, and to header sender and header recipient addresses. This allows you to use address masquerading on a mail gateway while still being able to forward mail to users on individual machines. </p> <p> Specify zero or more of: envelope_sender, envelope_recipient, header_sender, header_recipient </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="masquerade_domains">masquerade_domains</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional list of domains whose subdomain structure will be stripped off in email addresses. </p> <p> The list is processed left to right, and processing stops at the first match. Thus, </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#masquerade_domains">masquerade_domains</a> = foo.example.com example.com </pre> <p> strips "user@any.thing.foo.example.com" to "user@foo.example.com", but strips "user@any.thing.else.example.com" to "user@example.com". </p> <p> A domain name prefixed with ! means do not masquerade this domain or its subdomains. Thus, </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#masquerade_domains">masquerade_domains</a> = !foo.example.com example.com </pre> <p> does not change "user@any.thing.foo.example.com" or "user@foo.example.com", but strips "user@any.thing.else.example.com" to "user@example.com". </p> <p> Note: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address masquerading happens only when message header address rewriting is enabled: </p> <ul> <li> The message is received with the Postfix <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command, <li> The message is received from a network client that matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a>, <li> The message is received from the network, and the <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> parameter specifies a non-empty value. </ul> <p> To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = static:all". </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#masquerade_domains">masquerade_domains</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="masquerade_exceptions">masquerade_exceptions</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional list of user names that are not subjected to address masquerading, even when their address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#masquerade_domains">masquerade_domains</a>. </p> <p> By default, address masquerading makes no exceptions. </p> <p> Specify a list of user names, "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The list is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#masquerade_exceptions">masquerade_exceptions</a> = root, mailer-daemon <a href="postconf.5.html#masquerade_exceptions">masquerade_exceptions</a> = root </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="max_idle">max_idle</a> (default: 100s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximum amount of time that an idle Postfix daemon process waits for an incoming connection before terminating voluntarily. This parameter is ignored by the Postfix queue manager and by other long-lived Postfix daemon processes. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="max_use">max_use</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of incoming connections that a Postfix daemon process will service before terminating voluntarily. This parameter is ignored by the Postfix queue manager and by other long-lived Postfix daemon processes. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="maximal_backoff_time">maximal_backoff_time</a> (default: 4000s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal time between attempts to deliver a deferred message. </p> <p> This parameter should be set to a value greater than or equal to $<a href="postconf.5.html#minimal_backoff_time">minimal_backoff_time</a>. See also $<a href="postconf.5.html#queue_run_delay">queue_run_delay</a>. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="maximal_queue_lifetime">maximal_queue_lifetime</a> (default: 5d)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal time a message is queued before it is sent back as undeliverable. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is d (days). </p> <p> Specify 0 when mail delivery should be tried only once. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="message_reject_characters">message_reject_characters</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The set of characters that Postfix will reject in message content. The usual C-like escape sequences are recognized: <tt>\a \b \f \n \r \t \v \<i>ddd</i></tt> (up to three octal digits) and <tt>\\</tt>. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#message_reject_characters">message_reject_characters</a> = \0 </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="message_size_limit">message_size_limit</a> (default: 10240000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal size in bytes of a message, including envelope information. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="message_strip_characters">message_strip_characters</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The set of characters that Postfix will remove from message content. The usual C-like escape sequences are recognized: <tt>\a \b \f \n \r \t \v \<i>ddd</i></tt> (up to three octal digits) and <tt>\\</tt>. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#message_strip_characters">message_strip_characters</a> = \0 </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_command_timeout">milter_command_timeout</a> (default: 30s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for sending an SMTP command to a Milter (mail filter) application, and for receiving the response. </p> <p> Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the time unit). </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_connect_macros">milter_connect_macros</a> (default: see postconf -n output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after completion of an SMTP connection. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_connect_timeout">milter_connect_timeout</a> (default: 30s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for connecting to a Milter (mail filter) application, and for negotiating protocol options. </p> <p> Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the time unit). </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_content_timeout">milter_content_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for sending message content to a Milter (mail filter) application, and for receiving the response. </p> <p> Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the time unit). </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_data_macros">milter_data_macros</a> (default: see postconf -n output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The macros that are sent to version 4 or higher Milter (mail filter) applications after the SMTP DATA command. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_default_action">milter_default_action</a> (default: tempfail)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default action when a Milter (mail filter) application is unavailable or mis-configured. Specify one of the following: </p> <dl compact> <dt>accept</dt> <dd>Proceed as if the mail filter was not present. </dd> <dt>reject</dt> <dd>Reject all further commands in this session with a permanent status code.</dd> <dt>tempfail</dt> <dd>Reject all further commands in this session with a temporary status code. </dd> </dl> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_end_of_data_macros">milter_end_of_data_macros</a> (default: see postconf -n output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the message end-of-data. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_helo_macros">milter_helo_macros</a> (default: see postconf -n output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the SMTP HELO or EHLO command. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_macro_daemon_name">milter_macro_daemon_name</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The {daemon_name} macro value for Milter (mail filter) applications. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_macro_v">milter_macro_v</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#mail_name">mail_name</a> $<a href="postconf.5.html#mail_version">mail_version</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The {v} macro value for Milter (mail filter) applications. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_mail_macros">milter_mail_macros</a> (default: see postconf -n output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the SMTP MAIL FROM command. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_protocol">milter_protocol</a> (default: 2)</b></DT><DD> <p> The mail filter protocol version and optional protocol extensions for communication with a Milter (mail filter) application. This information should match the protocol that is expected by the actual mail filter application. </p> <p>Protocol versions: </p> <dl compact> <dt>2</dt> <dd>Use Sendmail 8 mail filter protocol version 2.</dd> <dt>3</dt> <dd>Use Sendmail 8 mail filter protocol version 3.</dd> <dt>4</dt> <dd>Use Sendmail 8 mail filter protocol version 4.</dd> </dl> <p>Protocol extensions: </p> <dl compact> <dt>no_header_reply</dt> <dd> Specify this when the Milter application will not reply for each individual message header.</dd> </dl> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_rcpt_macros">milter_rcpt_macros</a> (default: see postconf -n output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the SMTP RCPT TO command. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="milter_unknown_command_macros">milter_unknown_command_macros</a> (default: see postconf -n output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The macros that are sent to version 3 or higher Milter (mail filter) applications after an unknown SMTP command. See <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> for a list of available macro names and their meanings. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mime_boundary_length_limit">mime_boundary_length_limit</a> (default: 2048)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal length of MIME multipart boundary strings. The MIME processor is unable to distinguish between boundary strings that do not differ in the first $<a href="postconf.5.html#mime_boundary_length_limit">mime_boundary_length_limit</a> characters. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mime_header_checks">mime_header_checks</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#header_checks">header_checks</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables for content inspection of MIME related message headers, as described in the <a href="header_checks.5.html">header_checks(5)</a> manual page. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mime_nesting_limit">mime_nesting_limit</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal recursion level that the MIME processor will handle. Postfix refuses mail that is nested deeper than the specified limit. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="minimal_backoff_time">minimal_backoff_time</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The minimal time between attempts to deliver a deferred message; prior to Postfix 2.4 the default value was 1000s. </p> <p> This parameter also limits the time an unreachable destination is kept in the short-term, in-memory, destination status cache. </p> <p> This parameter should be set greater than or equal to $<a href="postconf.5.html#queue_run_delay">queue_run_delay</a>. See also $<a href="postconf.5.html#maximal_backoff_time">maximal_backoff_time</a>. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="multi_recipient_bounce_reject_code">multi_recipient_bounce_reject_code</a> (default: 550)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a remote SMTP client request is blocked by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_multi_recipient_bounce">reject_multi_recipient_bounce</a> restriction. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mydestination">mydestination</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>, localhost.$<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a>, localhost)</b></DT><DD> <p> The list of domains that are delivered via the $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_transport">local_transport</a> mail delivery transport. By default this is the Postfix <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent which looks up all recipients in /etc/passwd and /etc/aliases. The SMTP server validates recipient addresses with $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> and rejects non-existent recipients. See also the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html#local_domain_class">local domain</a> class in the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html">ADDRESS_CLASS_README</a> file. </p> <p> The default <a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a> value specifies names for the local machine only. On a mail domain gateway, you should also include $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a>. </p> <p> The $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_transport">local_transport</a> delivery method is also selected for mail addressed to user@[the.net.work.address] of the mail system (the IP addresses specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a> parameters). </p> <p> Warnings: </p> <ul> <li><p>Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are specified elsewhere. See <a href="VIRTUAL_README.html">VIRTUAL_README</a> for more information. </p> <li><p>Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX host for. See <a href="STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README.html">STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README</a> for how to set up backup MX hosts. </p> <li><p>By default, the Postfix SMTP server rejects mail for recipients not listed with the <a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> parameter. See the <a href="postconf.5.html">postconf(5)</a> manual for a description of the <a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#unknown_local_recipient_reject_code">unknown_local_recipient_reject_code</a> parameters. </p> </ul> <p> Specify a list of host or domain names, "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>, localhost.$<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>, localhost.$<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> www.$<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a>, ftp.$<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mydomain">mydomain</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The internet domain name of this mail system. The default is to use $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> minus the first component. $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> is used as a default value for many other configuration parameters. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> = domain.tld </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="myhostname">myhostname</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The internet hostname of this mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name from gethostname(). $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> is used as a default value for many other configuration parameters. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> = host.domain.tld </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mynetworks">mynetworks</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The list of "trusted" SMTP clients that have more privileges than "strangers". </p> <p> In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail through Postfix. See the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a> parameter description in the <a href="postconf.5.html">postconf(5)</a> manual. </p> <p> You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default). See the description of the <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks_style">mynetworks_style</a> parameter for more information. </p> <p> If you specify the <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> list by hand, Postfix ignores the <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks_style">mynetworks_style</a> setting. </p> <p> Specify a list of network addresses or network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. </p> <p> The netmask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host address. You can also specify "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored). </p> <p> The list is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside <tt>[]</tt> in the <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> value, and in files specified with "/file/name". IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be confused with a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" pattern. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> = 127.0.0.0/8 168.100.189.0/28 <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> = !192.168.0.1, 192.168.0.0/28 <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> = 127.0.0.0/8 168.100.189.0/28 [::1]/128 [2001:240:587::]/64 <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#config_directory">config_directory</a>/mynetworks <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="mynetworks_style">mynetworks_style</a> (default: subnet)</b></DT><DD> <p> The method to generate the default value for the <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> parameter. This is the list of trusted networks for relay access control etc. </p> <ul> <li><p>Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks_style">mynetworks_style</a> = host" when Postfix should "trust" only the local machine. </p> <li><p>Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks_style">mynetworks_style</a> = subnet" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine. On Linux, this works correctly only with interfaces specified with the "ifconfig" command. </p> <li><p>Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks_style">mynetworks_style</a> = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine. Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust" your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> list by hand, as described with the <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> configuration parameter. </p> </ul> </DD> <DT><b><a name="myorigin">myorigin</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The domain name that locally-posted mail appears to come from, and that locally posted mail is delivered to. The default, $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>, is adequate for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple machines, you should (1) change this to $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> and (2) set up a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to user@that.users.mailhost. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="nested_header_checks">nested_header_checks</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#header_checks">header_checks</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables for content inspection of non-MIME message headers in attached messages, as described in the <a href="header_checks.5.html">header_checks(5)</a> manual page. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="newaliases_path">newaliases_path</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> Sendmail compatibility feature that specifies the location of the <a href="newaliases.1.html">newaliases(1)</a> command. This command can be used to rebuild the <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> database. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="non_fqdn_reject_code">non_fqdn_reject_code</a> (default: 504)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server reply code when a client request is rejected by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname">reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_non_fqdn_sender">reject_non_fqdn_sender</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_non_fqdn_recipient">reject_non_fqdn_recipient</a> restriction. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="non_smtpd_milters">non_smtpd_milters</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> A list of Milter (mail filter) applications for new mail that does not arrive via the Postfix <a href="smtpd.8.html">smtpd(8)</a> server. This includes local submission via the <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command line, new mail that arrives via the Postfix <a href="qmqpd.8.html">qmqpd(8)</a> server, and old mail that is re-injected into the queue with "postsuper -r". See the <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> document for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="notify_classes">notify_classes</a> (default: resource, software)</b></DT><DD> <p> The list of error classes that are reported to the postmaster. The default is to report only the most serious problems. The paranoid may wish to turn on the policy (UCE and mail relaying) and protocol error (broken mail software) reports. </p> <p> NOTE: postmaster notifications may contain confidential information such as SASL passwords or message content. It is the system administrator's responsibility to treat such information with care. </p> <p> The error classes are: </p> <dl> <dt><b>bounce</b> (also implies <b>2bounce</b>)</dt> <dd>Send the postmaster copies of the headers of bounced mail, and send transcripts of SMTP sessions when Postfix rejects mail. The notification is sent to the address specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#bounce_notice_recipient">bounce_notice_recipient</a> configuration parameter (default: postmaster). </dd> <dt><b>2bounce</b></dt> <dd>Send undeliverable bounced mail to the postmaster. The notification is sent to the address specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#2bounce_notice_recipient">2bounce_notice_recipient</a> configuration parameter (default: postmaster). </dd> <dt><b>delay</b></dt> <dd>Send the postmaster copies of the headers of delayed mail. The notification is sent to the address specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#delay_notice_recipient">delay_notice_recipient</a> configuration parameter (default: postmaster). </dd> <dt><b>policy</b></dt> <dd>Send the postmaster a transcript of the SMTP session when a client request was rejected because of (UCE) policy. The notification is sent to the address specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#error_notice_recipient">error_notice_recipient</a> configuration parameter (default: postmaster). </dd> <dt><b>protocol</b></dt> <dd>Send the postmaster a transcript of the SMTP session in case of client or server protocol errors. The notification is sent to the address specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#error_notice_recipient">error_notice_recipient</a> configuration parameter (default: postmaster). </dd> <dt><b>resource</b></dt> <dd>Inform the postmaster of mail not delivered due to resource problems. The notification is sent to the address specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#error_notice_recipient">error_notice_recipient</a> configuration parameter (default: postmaster). </dd> <dt><b>software</b></dt> <dd>Inform the postmaster of mail not delivered due to software problems. The notification is sent to the address specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#error_notice_recipient">error_notice_recipient</a> configuration parameter (default: postmaster). </dd> </dl> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#notify_classes">notify_classes</a> = bounce, delay, policy, protocol, resource, software <a href="postconf.5.html#notify_classes">notify_classes</a> = 2bounce, resource, software </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="owner_request_special">owner_request_special</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Give special treatment to owner-listname and listname-request address localparts: don't split such addresses when the <a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_delimiter">recipient_delimiter</a> is set to "-". This feature is useful for mailing lists. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="parent_domain_matches_subdomains">parent_domain_matches_subdomains</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> What Postfix features match subdomains of "domain.tld" automatically, instead of requiring an explicit ".domain.tld" pattern. This is planned backwards compatibility: eventually, all Postfix features are expected to require explicit ".domain.tld" style patterns when you really want to match subdomains. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="permit_mx_backup_networks">permit_mx_backup_networks</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Restrict the use of the <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mx_backup">permit_mx_backup</a> SMTP access feature to only domains whose primary MX hosts match the listed networks. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="pickup_service_name">pickup_service_name</a> (default: pickup)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="pickup.8.html">pickup(8)</a> service. This service picks up local mail submissions from the Postfix <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#maildrop_queue">maildrop queue</a>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="plaintext_reject_code">plaintext_reject_code</a> (default: 450)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a request is rejected by the <b><a href="postconf.5.html#reject_plaintext_session">reject_plaintext_session</a></b> restriction. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="prepend_delivered_header">prepend_delivered_header</a> (default: command, file, forward)</b></DT><DD> <p> The message delivery contexts where the Postfix <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> delivery agent prepends a Delivered-To: message header with the address that the mail was delivered to. This information is used for mail delivery loop detection. </p> <p> By default, the Postfix local delivery agent prepends a Delivered-To: header when forwarding mail and when delivering to file (mailbox) and command. Turning off the Delivered-To: header when forwarding mail is not recommended. </p> <p> Specify zero or more of <b>forward</b>, <b>file</b>, or <b>command</b>. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#prepend_delivered_header">prepend_delivered_header</a> = forward </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="process_id">process_id</a> (read-only)</b></DT><DD> <p> The process ID of a Postfix command or daemon process. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="process_id_directory">process_id_directory</a> (default: pid)</b></DT><DD> <p> The location of Postfix PID files relative to $<a href="postconf.5.html#queue_directory">queue_directory</a>. This is a read-only parameter. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="process_name">process_name</a> (read-only)</b></DT><DD> <p> The process name of a Postfix command or daemon process. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="propagate_unmatched_extensions">propagate_unmatched_extensions</a> (default: canonical, virtual)</b></DT><DD> <p> What address lookup tables copy an address extension from the lookup key to the lookup result. </p> <p> For example, with a <a href="virtual.5.html">virtual(5)</a> mapping of "<i>joe@domain -> joe.user</i>", the address "<i>joe+foo@domain</i>" would rewrite to "<i>joe.user+foo</i>". </p> <p> Specify zero or more of <b>canonical</b>, <b>virtual</b>, <b>alias</b>, <b>forward</b>, <b>include</b> or <b>generic</b>. These cause address extension propagation with <a href="canonical.5.html">canonical(5)</a>, <a href="virtual.5.html">virtual(5)</a>, and <a href="aliases.5.html">aliases(5)</a> maps, with <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> .forward and :include: file lookups, and with <a href="smtp.8.html">smtp(8)</a> generic maps, respectively. </p> <p> Note: enabling this feature for types other than <b>canonical</b> and <b>virtual</b> is likely to cause problems when mail is forwarded to other sites, especially with mail that is sent to a mailing list exploder address. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#propagate_unmatched_extensions">propagate_unmatched_extensions</a> = canonical, virtual, alias, forward, include <a href="postconf.5.html#propagate_unmatched_extensions">propagate_unmatched_extensions</a> = canonical, virtual </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The network interface addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a proxy or network address translation unit. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> <p> You must specify your "outside" proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops will happen when the primary MX host is down. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a> = 1.2.3.4 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="proxy_read_maps">proxy_read_maps</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The lookup tables that the <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxymap(8)</a> server is allowed to access. Table references that don't begin with <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxy</a>: are ignored. The <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxymap(8)</a> table accesses are read-only. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="qmgr_clog_warn_time">qmgr_clog_warn_time</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The minimal delay between warnings that a specific destination is clogging up the Postfix <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#active_queue">active queue</a>. Specify 0 to disable. </p> <p> This feature is enabled with the <a href="postconf.5.html#helpful_warnings">helpful_warnings</a> parameter. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="qmgr_fudge_factor">qmgr_fudge_factor</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> Obsolete feature: the percentage of delivery resources that a busy mail system will use up for delivery of a large mailing list message. </p> <p> This feature exists only in the <a href="qmgr.8.html">oqmgr(8)</a> old queue manager. The current queue manager solves the problem in a better way. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="qmgr_message_active_limit">qmgr_message_active_limit</a> (default: 20000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of messages in the <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#active_queue">active queue</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="qmgr_message_recipient_limit">qmgr_message_recipient_limit</a> (default: 20000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipients held in memory by the Postfix queue manager, and the maximal size of the size of the short-term, in-memory "dead" destination status cache. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="qmgr_message_recipient_minimum">qmgr_message_recipient_minimum</a> (default: 10)</b></DT><DD> <p> The minimal number of in-memory recipients for any message. This takes priority over any other in-memory recipient limits (i.e., the global <a href="postconf.5.html#qmgr_message_recipient_limit">qmgr_message_recipient_limit</a> and the per transport _recipient_limit) if necessary. The minimum value allowed for this parameter is 1. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="qmqpd_authorized_clients">qmqpd_authorized_clients</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> What clients are allowed to connect to the QMQP server port. </p> <p> By default, no client is allowed to use the service. This is because the QMQP server will relay mail to any destination. </p> <p> Specify a list of client patterns. A list pattern specifies a host name, a domain name, an internet address, or a network/mask pattern, where the mask specifies the number of bits in the network part. When a pattern specifies a file name, its contents are substituted for the file name; when a pattern is a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" table specification, table lookup is used instead. </p> <p> Patterns are separated by whitespace and/or commas. In order to reverse the result, precede a pattern with an exclamation point (!). The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#qmqpd_authorized_clients">qmqpd_authorized_clients</a> = !192.168.0.1, 192.168.0.0/24 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="qmqpd_error_delay">qmqpd_error_delay</a> (default: 1s)</b></DT><DD> <p> How long the QMQP server will pause before sending a negative reply to the client. The purpose is to slow down confused or malicious clients. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="qmqpd_timeout">qmqpd_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for sending or receiving information over the network. If a read or write operation blocks for more than $<a href="postconf.5.html#qmqpd_timeout">qmqpd_timeout</a> seconds the QMQP server gives up and disconnects. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="queue_directory">queue_directory</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The location of the Postfix top-level queue directory. This is the root directory of Postfix daemon processes that run chrooted. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="queue_file_attribute_count_limit">queue_file_attribute_count_limit</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of (name=value) attributes that may be stored in a Postfix queue file. The limit is enforced by the <a href="cleanup.8.html">cleanup(8)</a> server. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="queue_minfree">queue_minfree</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> The minimal amount of free space in bytes in the queue file system that is needed to receive mail. This is currently used by the SMTP server to decide if it will accept any mail at all. </p> <p> By default, the Postfix version 2.1 SMTP server rejects MAIL FROM commands when the amount of free space is less than 1.5*$<a href="postconf.5.html#message_size_limit">message_size_limit</a>. To specify a higher minimum free space limit, specify a <a href="postconf.5.html#queue_minfree">queue_minfree</a> value that is at least 1.5*$<a href="postconf.5.html#message_size_limit">message_size_limit</a>. </p> <p> With Postfix versions 2.0 and earlier, a <a href="postconf.5.html#queue_minfree">queue_minfree</a> value of zero means there is no minimum required amount of free space. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="queue_run_delay">queue_run_delay</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time between <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#deferred_queue">deferred queue</a> scans by the queue manager; prior to Postfix 2.4 the default value was 1000s. </p> <p> This parameter should be set less than or equal to $<a href="postconf.5.html#minimal_backoff_time">minimal_backoff_time</a>. See also $<a href="postconf.5.html#maximal_backoff_time">maximal_backoff_time</a>. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="queue_service_name">queue_service_name</a> (default: qmgr)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="qmgr.8.html">qmgr(8)</a> service. This service manages the Postfix queue and schedules delivery requests. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="rbl_reply_maps">rbl_reply_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with RBL response templates. The tables are indexed by the RBL domain name. By default, Postfix uses the default template as specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#default_rbl_reply">default_rbl_reply</a> configuration parameter. See there for a discussion of the syntax of RBL reply templates. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="readme_directory">readme_directory</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The location of Postfix README files that describe how to build, configure or operate a specific Postfix subsystem or feature. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="receive_override_options">receive_override_options</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable or disable recipient validation, built-in content filtering, or address mapping. Typically, these are specified in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> as command-line arguments for the <a href="smtpd.8.html">smtpd(8)</a>, <a href="qmqpd.8.html">qmqpd(8)</a> or <a href="pickup.8.html">pickup(8)</a> daemons. </p> <p> Specify zero or more of the following options. The options override <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> settings and are either implemented by <a href="smtpd.8.html">smtpd(8)</a>, <a href="qmqpd.8.html">qmqpd(8)</a>, or <a href="pickup.8.html">pickup(8)</a> themselves, or they are forwarded to the cleanup server. </p> <dl> <dt><b><a name="no_unknown_recipient_checks">no_unknown_recipient_checks</a></b></dt> <dd>Do not try to reject unknown recipients (SMTP server only). This is typically specified AFTER an external content filter. </dd> <dt><b><a name="no_address_mappings">no_address_mappings</a></b></dt> <dd>Disable canonical address mapping, virtual alias map expansion, address masquerading, and automatic BCC (blind carbon-copy) recipients. This is typically specified BEFORE an external content filter. </dd> <dt><b><a name="no_header_body_checks">no_header_body_checks</a></b></dt> <dd>Disable header/body_checks. This is typically specified AFTER an external content filter. </dd> <dt><b><a name="no_milters">no_milters</a></b></dt> <dd>Disable Milter (mail filter) applications. This is typically specified AFTER an external content filter. </dd> </dl> <p> Note: when the "BEFORE content filter" <a href="postconf.5.html#receive_override_options">receive_override_options</a> setting is specified in the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> file, specify the "AFTER content filter" <a href="postconf.5.html#receive_override_options">receive_override_options</a> setting in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> (and vice versa). </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#receive_override_options">receive_override_options</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#no_unknown_recipient_checks">no_unknown_recipient_checks</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#no_header_body_checks">no_header_body_checks</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#receive_override_options">receive_override_options</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#no_address_mappings">no_address_mappings</a> </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="recipient_bcc_maps">recipient_bcc_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional BCC (blind carbon-copy) address lookup tables, indexed by recipient address. The BCC address (multiple results are not supported) is added when mail enters from outside of Postfix. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> <p> The table search order is as follows: </p> <ul> <li> Look up the "user+extension@domain.tld" address including the optional address extension. <li> Look up the "user@domain.tld" address without the optional address extension. <li> Look up the "user+extension" address local part when the recipient domain equals $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>. <li> Look up the "user" address local part when the recipient domain equals $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>. <li> Look up the "@domain.tld" part. </ul> <p> Specify the types and names of databases to use. After change, run "<b>postmap /etc/postfix/recipient_bcc</b>". </p> <p> Note: if mail to the BCC address bounces it will be returned to the sender. </p> <p> Note: automatic BCC recipients are produced only for new mail. To avoid mailer loops, automatic BCC recipients are not generated for mail that Postfix forwards internally, nor for mail that Postfix generates itself. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_bcc_maps">recipient_bcc_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/recipient_bcc </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="recipient_canonical_classes">recipient_canonical_classes</a> (default: envelope_recipient, header_recipient)</b></DT><DD> <p> What addresses are subject to <a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_canonical_maps">recipient_canonical_maps</a> address mapping. By default, <a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_canonical_maps">recipient_canonical_maps</a> address mapping is applied to envelope recipient addresses, and to header recipient addresses. </p> <p> Specify one or more of: envelope_recipient, header_recipient </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="recipient_canonical_maps">recipient_canonical_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional address mapping lookup tables for envelope and header recipient addresses. The table format and lookups are documented in <a href="canonical.5.html">canonical(5)</a>. </p> <p> Note: $<a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_canonical_maps">recipient_canonical_maps</a> is processed before $<a href="postconf.5.html#canonical_maps">canonical_maps</a>. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_canonical_maps">recipient_canonical_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/recipient_canonical </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="recipient_delimiter">recipient_delimiter</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The separator between user names and address extensions (user+foo). See <a href="canonical.5.html">canonical(5)</a>, <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a>, <a href="relocated.5.html">relocated(5)</a> and <a href="virtual.5.html">virtual(5)</a> for the effects this has on aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and on .forward file lookups. Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before trying user and .forward. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#recipient_delimiter">recipient_delimiter</a> = + </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="reject_code">reject_code</a> (default: 554)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a remote SMTP client request is rejected by the "reject" restriction. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relay_clientcerts">relay_clientcerts</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The list of remote SMTP client certificates for which the Postfix SMTP server will allow access with the <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_tls_clientcerts">permit_tls_clientcerts</a> feature. This feature does not use certificate names, because Postfix list manipulation routines treat whitespace and some other characters as special. Instead we use certificate fingerprints as they are difficult to fake but easy to use for lookup. </p> <p> Postfix lookup tables are in the form of (key, value) pairs. Since we only need the key, the value can be chosen freely, e.g. the name of the user or host: D7:04:2F:A7:0B:8C:A5:21:FA:31:77:E1:41:8A:EE:80 lutzpc.at.home </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_clientcerts">relay_clientcerts</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_clientcerts </pre> <p>For more fine-grained control, use <a href="postconf.5.html#check_ccert_access">check_ccert_access</a> to select an appropriate <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> policy for each client. See <a href="RESTRICTION_CLASS_README.html">RESTRICTION_CLASS_README</a>.</p> <p>This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.</p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relay_destination_concurrency_limit">relay_destination_concurrency_limit</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_destination_concurrency_limit">default_destination_concurrency_limit</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same destination via the relay message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relay_destination_recipient_limit">relay_destination_recipient_limit</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_destination_recipient_limit">default_destination_recipient_limit</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipients per delivery via the relay message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> <p> Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the meaning of <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_destination_concurrency_limit">relay_destination_concurrency_limit</a> from concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relay_domains">relay_domains</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> What destination domains (and subdomains thereof) this system will relay mail to. Subdomain matching is controlled with the <a href="postconf.5.html#parent_domain_matches_subdomains">parent_domain_matches_subdomains</a> parameter. For details about how the <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a> value is used, see the description of the <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_auth_destination">permit_auth_destination</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_destination">reject_unauth_destination</a> SMTP recipient restrictions. </p> <p> Domains that match $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a> are delivered with the $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a> mail delivery transport. The SMTP server validates recipient addresses with $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a> and rejects non-existent recipients. See also the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html#relay_domain_class">relay domains</a> address class in the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html">ADDRESS_CLASS_README</a> file. </p> <p> Note: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mx_backup">permit_mx_backup</a> restriction in the <a href="postconf.5.html">postconf(5)</a> manual page. </p> <p> Specify a list of host or domain names, "/file/name" patterns or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a (parent) domain appears as lookup key. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a domain from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relay_domains_reject_code">relay_domains_reject_code</a> (default: 554)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a client request is rejected by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_destination">reject_unauth_destination</a> recipient restriction. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with all valid addresses in the domains that match $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a>. Specify @domain as a wild-card for domains that have no valid recipient list, and become a source of backscatter mail: Postfix accepts spam for non-existent recipients and then floods innocent people with undeliverable mail. Technically, tables listed with $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a> are used as lists: Postfix needs to know only if a lookup string is found or not, but it does not use the result from table lookup. </p> <p> If this parameter is non-empty, then the Postfix SMTP server will reject mail to unknown relay users. This feature is off by default. </p> <p> See also the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html#relay_domain_class">relay domains</a> address class in the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html">ADDRESS_CLASS_README</a> file. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relay_transport">relay_transport</a> (default: relay)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for remote delivery to domains listed with $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a>. In order of decreasing precedence, the nexthop destination is taken from $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#sender_dependent_relayhost_maps">sender_dependent_relayhost_maps</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a>, or from the recipient domain. This information can be overruled with the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. </p> <p> Specify a string of the form <i>transport:nexthop</i>, where <i>transport</i> is the name of a mail delivery transport defined in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>. The <i>:nexthop</i> part is optional. For more details see the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> manual page. </p> <p> See also the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html#relay_domain_class">relay domains</a> address class in the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html">ADDRESS_CLASS_README</a> file. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relayhost">relayhost</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The next-hop destination of non-local mail; overrides non-local domains in recipient addresses. This information is overruled with <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#default_transport">default_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#sender_dependent_relayhost_maps">sender_dependent_relayhost_maps</a> and with the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. </p> <p> On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet gateway host instead. </p> <p> In the case of SMTP, specify a domain name, hostname, hostname:port, [hostname]:port, [hostaddress] or [hostaddress]:port. The form [hostname] turns off MX lookups. </p> <p> If you're connected via UUCP, see the <a href="UUCP_README.html">UUCP_README</a> file for useful information. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a> = [gateway.my.domain] <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a> = uucphost <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a> = [an.ip.add.ress] </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="relocated_maps">relocated_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with new contact information for users or domains that no longer exist. The table format and lookups are documented in <a href="relocated.5.html">relocated(5)</a>. </p> <p> If you use this feature, run "<b>postmap /etc/postfix/relocated</b>" to build the necessary DBM or DB file after change, then "<b>postfix reload</b>" to make the changes visible. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#relocated_maps">relocated_maps</a> = dbm:/etc/postfix/relocated <a href="postconf.5.html#relocated_maps">relocated_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/relocated </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Don't rewrite message headers from remote clients at all when this parameter is empty; otherwise, rewrite message headers and append the specified domain name to incomplete addresses. The <a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> parameter controls what clients Postfix considers local. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <p> The safe setting: append "domain.invalid" to incomplete header addresses from remote SMTP clients, so that those addresses cannot be confused with local addresses. </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> = domain.invalid </pre> <p> The default, purist, setting: don't rewrite headers from remote clients at all. </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> = </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="require_home_directory">require_home_directory</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Whether or not a <a href="local.8.html">local(8)</a> recipient's home directory must exist before mail delivery is attempted. By default this test is disabled. It can be useful for environments that import home directories to the mail server (NOT RECOMMENDED). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="resolve_dequoted_address">resolve_dequoted_address</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Resolve a recipient address safely instead of correctly, by looking inside quotes. </p> <p> By default, the Postfix address resolver does not quote the address localpart as per <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc822.html">RFC 822</a>, so that additional @ or % or ! operators remain visible. This behavior is safe but it is also technically incorrect. </p> <p> If you specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#resolve_dequoted_address">resolve_dequoted_address</a> = no", then the Postfix resolver will not know about additional @ etc. operators in the address localpart. This opens opportunities for obscure mail relay attacks with user@domain@domain addresses when Postfix provides backup MX service for Sendmail systems. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="resolve_null_domain">resolve_null_domain</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Resolve an address that ends in the "@" null domain as if the local hostname were specified, instead of rejecting the address as invalid. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. Earlier versions always resolve the null domain as the local hostname. </p> <p> The Postfix SMTP server uses this feature to reject mail from or to addresses that end in the "@" null domain, and from addresses that rewrite into a form that ends in the "@" null domain. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="resolve_numeric_domain">resolve_numeric_domain</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Resolve "user@ipaddress" as "user@[ipaddress]", instead of rejecting the address as invalid. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </DD> <DT><b><a name="rewrite_service_name">rewrite_service_name</a> (default: rewrite)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the address rewriting service. This service rewrites addresses to standard form and resolves them to a (delivery method, next-hop host, recipient) triple. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="sample_directory">sample_directory</a> (default: /etc/postfix)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the directory with example Postfix configuration files. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="sender_based_routing">sender_based_routing</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> This parameter should not be used. It was replaced by <a href="postconf.5.html#sender_dependent_relayhost_maps">sender_dependent_relayhost_maps</a> in Postfix version 2.3. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="sender_bcc_maps">sender_bcc_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional BCC (blind carbon-copy) address lookup tables, indexed by sender address. The BCC address (multiple results are not supported) is added when mail enters from outside of Postfix. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> <p> The table search order is as follows: </p> <ul> <li> Look up the "user+extension@domain.tld" address including the optional address extension. <li> Look up the "user@domain.tld" address without the optional address extension. <li> Look up the "user+extension" address local part when the sender domain equals $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>. <li> Look up the "user" address local part when the sender domain equals $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>. <li> Look up the "@domain.tld" part. </ul> <p> Specify the types and names of databases to use. After change, run "<b>postmap /etc/postfix/sender_bcc</b>". </p> <p> Note: if mail to the BCC address bounces it will be returned to the sender. </p> <p> Note: automatic BCC recipients are produced only for new mail. To avoid mailer loops, automatic BCC recipients are not generated for mail that Postfix forwards internally, nor for mail that Postfix generates itself. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#sender_bcc_maps">sender_bcc_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/sender_bcc </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="sender_canonical_classes">sender_canonical_classes</a> (default: envelope_sender, header_sender)</b></DT><DD> <p> What addresses are subject to <a href="postconf.5.html#sender_canonical_maps">sender_canonical_maps</a> address mapping. By default, <a href="postconf.5.html#sender_canonical_maps">sender_canonical_maps</a> address mapping is applied to envelope sender addresses, and to header sender addresses. </p> <p> Specify one or more of: envelope_sender, header_sender </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="sender_canonical_maps">sender_canonical_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional address mapping lookup tables for envelope and header sender addresses. The table format and lookups are documented in <a href="canonical.5.html">canonical(5)</a>. </p> <p> Example: you want to rewrite the SENDER address "user@ugly.domain" to "user@pretty.domain", while still being able to send mail to the RECIPIENT address "user@ugly.domain". </p> <p> Note: $<a href="postconf.5.html#sender_canonical_maps">sender_canonical_maps</a> is processed before $<a href="postconf.5.html#canonical_maps">canonical_maps</a>. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#sender_canonical_maps">sender_canonical_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/sender_canonical </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="sender_dependent_relayhost_maps">sender_dependent_relayhost_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> A sender-dependent override for the global <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a> parameter setting. The tables are searched by the envelope sender address and @domain. This information is overruled with <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#default_transport">default_transport</a> and with the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. </p> <p> For safety reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions in regular expression maps. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="sendmail_path">sendmail_path</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> A Sendmail compatibility feature that specifies the location of the Postfix <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command. This command can be used to submit mail into the Postfix queue. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="service_throttle_time">service_throttle_time</a> (default: 60s)</b></DT><DD> <p> How long the Postfix <a href="master.8.html">master(8)</a> waits before forking a server that appears to be malfunctioning. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="setgid_group">setgid_group</a> (default: postdrop)</b></DT><DD> <p> The group ownership of set-gid Postfix commands and of group-writable Postfix directories. When this parameter value is changed you need to re-run "<b>postfix set-permissions</b>" (with Postfix version 2.0 and earlier: "<b>/etc/postfix/post-install set-permissions</b>". </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="show_user_unknown_table_name">show_user_unknown_table_name</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Display the name of the recipient table in the "User unknown" responses. The extra detail makes trouble shooting easier but also reveals information that is nobody elses business. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="showq_service_name">showq_service_name</a> (default: showq)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the <a href="showq.8.html">showq(8)</a> service. This service produces mail queue status reports. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_always_send_ehlo">smtp_always_send_ehlo</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Always send EHLO at the start of an SMTP session. </p> <p> With "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_always_send_ehlo">smtp_always_send_ehlo</a> = no", Postfix sends EHLO only when the word "ESMTP" appears in the server greeting banner (example: 220 spike.porcupine.org ESMTP Postfix). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_bind_address">smtp_bind_address</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> An optional numerical network address that the Postfix SMTP client should bind to when making an IPv4 connection. </p> <p> This can be specified in the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> file for all SMTP clients, or it can be specified in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file for a specific client, for example: </p> <pre> /etc/postfix/<a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>: smtp ... smtp -o <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_bind_address">smtp_bind_address</a>=11.22.33.44 </pre> <p> Note 1: when <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> specifies no more than one IPv4 address, and that address is a non-loopback address, it is automatically used as the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_bind_address">smtp_bind_address</a>. This supports virtual IP hosting, but can be a problem on multi-homed firewalls. See the <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> documentation for more detail. </p> <p> Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside <tt>[]</tt>, but this form is not required here. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_bind_address6">smtp_bind_address6</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> An optional numerical network address that the Postfix SMTP client should bind to when making an IPv6 connection. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> This can be specified in the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> file for all SMTP clients, or it can be specified in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file for a specific client, for example: </p> <pre> /etc/postfix/<a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>: smtp ... smtp -o <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_bind_address6">smtp_bind_address6</a>=1:2:3:4:5:6:7:8 </pre> <p> Note 1: when <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> specifies no more than one IPv6 address, and that address is a non-loopback address, it is automatically used as the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_bind_address6">smtp_bind_address6</a>. This supports virtual IP hosting, but can be a problem on multi-homed firewalls. See the <a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> documentation for more detail. </p> <p> Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside <tt>[]</tt>, but this form is not recommended here. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_cname_overrides_servername">smtp_cname_overrides_servername</a> (default: version dependent)</b></DT><DD> <p> Allow DNS CNAME records to override the servername that the Postfix SMTP client uses for logging, SASL password lookup, TLS policy decisions, or TLS certificate verification. The value "no" hardens Postfix <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_per_site">smtp_tls_per_site</a> hostname-based policies against false hostname information in DNS CNAME records, and makes SASL password file lookups more predictable. This is the default setting as of Postfix 2.3. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2.9 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_connect_timeout">smtp_connect_timeout</a> (default: 30s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for completing a TCP connection, or zero (use the operating system built-in time limit). </p> <p> When no connection can be made within the deadline, the Postfix SMTP client tries the next address on the mail exchanger list. Specify 0 to disable the time limit (i.e. use whatever timeout is implemented by the operating system). </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_connection_cache_destinations">smtp_connection_cache_destinations</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Permanently enable SMTP connection caching for the specified destinations. With SMTP connection caching, a connection is not closed immediately after completion of a mail transaction. Instead, the connection is kept open for up to $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_connection_cache_time_limit">smtp_connection_cache_time_limit</a> seconds. This allows connections to be reused for other deliveries, and can improve mail delivery performance. </p> <p> Specify a comma or white space separated list of destinations or pseudo-destinations: </p> <ul> <li> if mail is sent without a <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relay host</a>: a domain name (the right-hand side of an email address, without the [] around a numeric IP address), <li> if mail is sent via a <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relay host</a>: a <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relay host</a> name (without [] or non-default TCP port), as specified in <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> or in the transport map, <li> if mail is sent via a UNIX-domain socket: a pathname (without the unix: prefix), <li> a /file/name with domain names and/or <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relay host</a> names as defined above, <li> a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" with domain names and/or relay hosts name on the left-hand side. The right-hand side result from "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookups is ignored. </ul> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_connection_cache_on_demand">smtp_connection_cache_on_demand</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Temporarily enable SMTP connection caching while a destination has a high volume of mail in the <a href="QSHAPE_README.html#active_queue">active queue</a>. With SMTP connection caching, a connection is not closed immediately after completion of a mail transaction. Instead, the connection is kept open for up to $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_connection_cache_time_limit">smtp_connection_cache_time_limit</a> seconds. This allows connections to be reused for other deliveries, and can improve mail delivery performance. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_connection_cache_reuse_limit">smtp_connection_cache_reuse_limit</a> (default: 10)</b></DT><DD> <p> When SMTP connection caching is enabled, the number of times that an SMTP session may be reused before it is closed. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2. In Postfix 2.3 it is replaced by $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit">smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit</a>.</p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_connection_cache_time_limit">smtp_connection_cache_time_limit</a> (default: 2s)</b></DT><DD> <p> When SMTP connection caching is enabled, the amount of time that an unused SMTP client socket is kept open before it is closed. Do not specify larger values without permission from the remote sites. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit">smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The amount of time during which Postfix will use an SMTP connection repeatedly. The timer starts when the connection is initiated (i.e. it includes the connect, greeting and helo latency, in addition to the latencies of subsequent mail delivery transactions). </p> <p> This feature addresses a performance stability problem with remote SMTP servers. This problem is not specific to Postfix: it can happen when any MTA sends large amounts of SMTP email to a site that has multiple MX hosts. </p> <p> The problem starts when one of a set of MX hosts becomes slower than the rest. Even though SMTP clients connect to fast and slow MX hosts with equal probability, the slow MX host ends up with more simultaneous inbound connections than the faster MX hosts, because the slow MX host needs more time to serve each client request. </p> <p> The slow MX host becomes a connection attractor. If one MX host becomes N times slower than the rest, it dominates mail delivery latency unless there are more than N fast MX hosts to counter the effect. And if the number of MX hosts is smaller than N, the mail delivery latency becomes effectively that of the slowest MX host divided by the total number of MX hosts. </p> <p> The solution uses connection caching in a way that differs from Postfix version 2.2. By limiting the amount of time during which a connection can be used repeatedly (instead of limiting the number of deliveries over that connection), Postfix not only restores fairness in the distribution of simultaneous connections across a set of MX hosts, it also favors deliveries over connections that perform well, which is exactly what we want. </p> <p> The default reuse time limit, 300s, is comparable to the various smtp transaction timeouts which are fair estimates of maximum excess latency for a slow delivery. Note that hosts may accept thousands of messages over a single connection within the default connection reuse time limit. This number is much larger than the default Postfix version 2.2 limit of 10 messages per cached connection. It may prove necessary to lower the limit to avoid interoperability issues with MTAs that exhibit bugs when many messages are delivered via a single connection. A lower reuse time limit risks losing the benefit of connection reuse when the average connection and mail delivery latency exceeds the reuse time limit. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_data_done_timeout">smtp_data_done_timeout</a> (default: 600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the SMTP ".", and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> When no response is received within the deadline, a warning is logged that the mail may be delivered multiple times. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_data_init_timeout">smtp_data_init_timeout</a> (default: 120s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the SMTP DATA command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_data_xfer_timeout">smtp_data_xfer_timeout</a> (default: 180s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the SMTP message content. When the connection makes no progress for more than $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_data_xfer_timeout">smtp_data_xfer_timeout</a> seconds the Postfix SMTP client terminates the transfer. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found">smtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Defer mail delivery when no MX record resolves to an IP address. </p> <p> The default (no) is to return the mail as undeliverable. With older Postfix versions the default was to keep trying to deliver the mail until someone fixed the MX record or until the mail was too old. </p> <p> Note: Postfix always ignores MX records with equal or worse preference than the local MTA itself. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_destination_concurrency_limit">smtp_destination_concurrency_limit</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_destination_concurrency_limit">default_destination_concurrency_limit</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same destination via the smtp message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_destination_recipient_limit">smtp_destination_recipient_limit</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_destination_recipient_limit">default_destination_recipient_limit</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipients per delivery via the smtp message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> <p> Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the meaning of <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_destination_concurrency_limit">smtp_destination_concurrency_limit</a> from concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps">smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Lookup tables, indexed by the remote SMTP server address, with case insensitive lists of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the Postfix SMTP client will ignore in the EHLO response from a remote SMTP server. See <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_discard_ehlo_keywords">smtp_discard_ehlo_keywords</a> for details. The table is not indexed by hostname for consistency with <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps">smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps</a>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_discard_ehlo_keywords">smtp_discard_ehlo_keywords</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> A case insensitive list of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the Postfix SMTP client will ignore in the EHLO response from a remote SMTP server. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> Notes: </p> <ul> <li> <p> Specify the <b>silent-discard</b> pseudo keyword to prevent this action from being logged. </p> <li> <p> Use the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps">smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps</a> feature to discard EHLO keywords selectively. </p> </ul> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_enforce_tls">smtp_enforce_tls</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enforcement mode: require that remote SMTP servers use TLS encryption, and never send mail in the clear. This also requires that the remote SMTP server hostname matches the information in the remote server certificate, and that the remote SMTP server certificate was issued by a CA that is trusted by the Postfix SMTP client. If the certificate doesn't verify or the hostname doesn't match, delivery is deferred and mail stays in the queue. </p> <p> The server hostname is matched against all names provided as dNSNames in the SubjectAlternativeName. If no dNSNames are specified, the CommonName is checked. The behavior may be changed with the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_enforce_peername">smtp_tls_enforce_peername</a> option. </p> <p> This option is useful only if you are definitely sure that you will only connect to servers that support <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc2487.html">RFC 2487</a> _and_ that provide valid server certificates. Typical use is for clients that send all their email to a dedicated mailhub. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3 and later use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_fallback_relay">smtp_fallback_relay</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_relay">fallback_relay</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional list of relay hosts for SMTP destinations that can't be found or that are unreachable. With Postfix 2.2 and earlier this parameter is called <a href="postconf.5.html#fallback_relay">fallback_relay</a>. </p> <p> By default, mail is returned to the sender when a destination is not found, and delivery is deferred when a destination is unreachable. </p> <p> The fallback relays must be SMTP destinations. Specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port, [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups. If you specify multiple SMTP destinations, Postfix will try them in the specified order. </p> <p> To prevent mailer loops between MX hosts and fall-back hosts, Postfix version 2.3 and later will not use the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_fallback_relay">smtp_fallback_relay</a> feature for destinations that it is MX host for. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_generic_maps">smtp_generic_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables that perform address rewriting in the SMTP client, typically to transform a locally valid address into a globally valid address when sending mail across the Internet. This is needed when the local machine does not have its own Internet domain name, but uses something like <i>localdomain.local</i> instead. </p> <p> The table format and lookups are documented in <a href="generic.5.html">generic(5)</a>; examples are shown in the <a href="ADDRESS_REWRITING_README.html">ADDRESS_REWRITING_README</a> and <a href="STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README.html">STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README</a> documents. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_helo_name">smtp_helo_name</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The hostname to send in the SMTP EHLO or HELO command. </p> <p> The default value is the machine hostname. Specify a hostname or [ip.add.re.ss]. </p> <p> This information can be specified in the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> file for all SMTP clients, or it can be specified in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file for a specific client, for example: </p> <pre> /etc/postfix/<a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>: mysmtp ... smtp -o <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_helo_name">smtp_helo_name</a>=foo.bar.com </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_helo_timeout">smtp_helo_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the HELO or EHLO command, and for receiving the initial server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_host_lookup">smtp_host_lookup</a> (default: dns)</b></DT><DD> <p> What mechanisms when the Postfix SMTP client uses to look up a host's IP address. This parameter is ignored when DNS lookups are disabled. </p> <p> Specify one of the following: </p> <dl> <dt><b>dns</b></dt> <dd>Hosts can be found in the DNS (preferred). </dd> <dt><b>native</b></dt> <dd>Use the native naming service only (nsswitch.conf, or equivalent mechanism). </dd> <dt><b>dns, native</b></dt> <dd>Use the native service for hosts not found in the DNS. </dd> </dl> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_line_length_limit">smtp_line_length_limit</a> (default: 990)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal length of message header and body lines that Postfix will send via SMTP. Longer lines are broken by inserting "<CR><LF><SPACE>". This minimizes the damage to MIME formatted mail. </p> <p> By default, the line length is limited to 990 characters, because some server implementations cannot receive mail with long lines. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_mail_timeout">smtp_mail_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the MAIL FROM command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_mx_address_limit">smtp_mx_address_limit</a> (default: 5)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of MX (mail exchanger) IP addresses that can result from mail exchanger lookups, or zero (no limit). Prior to Postfix version 2.3, this limit was disabled by default. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_mx_session_limit">smtp_mx_session_limit</a> (default: 2)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of SMTP sessions per delivery request before giving up or delivering to a fall-back <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relay host</a>, or zero (no limit). This restriction ignores sessions that fail to complete the SMTP initial handshake (Postfix version 2.2 and earlier) or that fail to complete the EHLO and TLS handshake (Postfix version 2.3 and later). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_never_send_ehlo">smtp_never_send_ehlo</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Never send EHLO at the start of an SMTP session. See also the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_always_send_ehlo">smtp_always_send_ehlo</a> parameter. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time">smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time</a> (default: 10s)</b></DT><DD> <p> How long the Postfix SMTP client pauses before sending ".<CR><LF>" in order to work around the PIX firewall "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug. </p> <p> Choosing a too short time makes this workaround ineffective when sending large messages over slow network connections. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_pix_workaround_maps">smtp_pix_workaround_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Lookup tables, indexed by the remote SMTP server address, with per-destination workarounds for CISCO PIX firewall bugs. The table is not indexed by hostname for consistency with <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps">smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps</a>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time">smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time</a> (default: 500s)</b></DT><DD> <p> How long a message must be queued before the Postfix SMTP client turns on the PIX firewall "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug workaround for delivery through firewalls with "smtp fixup" mode turned on. </p> <p> By default, the workaround is turned off for mail that is queued for less than 500 seconds. In other words, the workaround is normally turned off for the first delivery attempt. </p> <p> Specify 0 to enable the PIX firewall "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug workaround upon the first delivery attempt. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_pix_workarounds">smtp_pix_workarounds</a> (default: disable_esmtp, delay_dotcrlf)</b></DT><DD> <p> A list that specifies zero or more workarounds for CISCO PIX firewall bugs. These workarounds are implemented by the Postfix SMTP client. Workaround names are separated by comma or space, and are case insensitive. This parameter setting can be overruled with per-destination <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_pix_workaround_maps">smtp_pix_workaround_maps</a> settings. </p> <dl> <dt><b>delay_dotcrlf</b><dd> Insert a delay before sending ".<CR><LF>" after the end of the message content. The delay is subject to the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time">smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time">smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time</a> parameter settings. </dd> <dt><b>disable_esmtp</b><dd> Disable all extended SMTP commands: send HELO instead of EHLO. </dd> </dl> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later. The default settings are backwards compatible with earlier Postfix versions. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_quit_timeout">smtp_quit_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the QUIT command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope">smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Quote addresses in SMTP MAIL FROM and RCPT TO commands as required by <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. This includes putting quotes around an address localpart that ends in ".". </p> <p> The default is to comply with <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. If you have to send mail to a broken SMTP server, configure a special SMTP client in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>: </p> <pre> /etc/postfix/<a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>: broken-smtp . . . smtp -o <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope">smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope</a>=no </pre> <p> and route mail for the destination in question to the "broken-smtp" message delivery with a <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_randomize_addresses">smtp_randomize_addresses</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Randomize the order of equal-preference MX host addresses. This is a performance feature of the Postfix SMTP client. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_rcpt_timeout">smtp_rcpt_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the SMTP RCPT TO command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_rset_timeout">smtp_rset_timeout</a> (default: 20s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the RSET command, and for receiving the server response. The SMTP client sends RSET in order to finish a recipient address probe, or to verify that a cached session is still usable. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sasl_auth_enable">smtp_sasl_auth_enable</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable SASL authentication in the Postfix SMTP client. By default, the Postfix SMTP client uses no authentication. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_auth_enable">smtp_sasl_auth_enable</a> = yes </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter">smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> If non-empty, a Postfix SMTP client filter for the remote SMTP server's list of offered SASL mechanisms. Different client and server implementations may support different mechanism lists. By default, the Postfix SMTP client will use the intersection of the two. <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter">smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter</a> further restricts what server mechanisms the client will take into consideration. </p> <p> Specify mechanism names, "/file/name" patterns or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup tables. The right-hand side result from "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookups is ignored. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a mechanism name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter">smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter</a> = plain, login <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter">smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter</a> = /etc/postfix/smtp_mechs <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter">smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter</a> = !gssapi, !login, static:rest </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sasl_password_maps">smtp_sasl_password_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional SMTP client lookup tables with one username:password entry per remote hostname or domain, or sender address when sender-dependent authentication is enabled. If no username:password entry is found, then the Postfix SMTP client will not attempt to authenticate to the remote host. </p> <p> The Postfix SMTP client opens the lookup table before going to chroot jail, so you can leave the password file in /etc/postfix. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sasl_path">smtp_sasl_path</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Implementation-specific information that is passed through to the SASL plug-in implementation that is selected with <b><a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_type">smtp_sasl_type</a></b>. Typically this specifies the name of a configuration file or rendezvous point. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sasl_security_options">smtp_sasl_security_options</a> (default: noplaintext, noanonymous)</b></DT><DD> <p> SASL security options; as of Postfix 2.3 the list of available features depends on the SASL client implementation that is selected with <b><a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_type">smtp_sasl_type</a></b>. </p> <p> The following security features are defined for the <b>cyrus</b> client SASL implementation: </p> <p> Specify zero or more of the following: </p> <dl> <dt><b>noplaintext</b></dt> <dd>Disallow methods that use plaintext passwords. </dd> <dt><b>noactive</b></dt> <dd>Disallow methods subject to active (non-dictionary) attack. </dd> <dt><b>nodictionary</b></dt> <dd>Disallow methods subject to passive (dictionary) attack. </dd> <dt><b>noanonymous</b></dt> <dd>Disallow methods that allow anonymous authentication. </dd> <dt><b>mutual_auth</b></dt> <dd>Only allow methods that provide mutual authentication (not available with SASL version 1). </dd> </dl> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_security_options">smtp_sasl_security_options</a> = noplaintext </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sasl_tls_security_options">smtp_sasl_tls_security_options</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_security_options">smtp_sasl_security_options</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SASL authentication security options that the Postfix SMTP client uses for TLS encrypted SMTP sessions. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options">smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_sasl_tls_security_options">smtp_sasl_tls_security_options</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SASL authentication security options that the Postfix SMTP client uses for TLS encrypted SMTP sessions with a verified server certificate. This feature is still under construction. It will not be included in the Postfix 2.3 release. </p> <p> This feature should be available in Postfix 2.4 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sasl_type">smtp_sasl_type</a> (default: cyrus)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SASL plug-in type that the Postfix SMTP client should use for authentication. The available types are listed with the "<b>postconf -A</b>" command. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_send_xforward_command">smtp_send_xforward_command</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Send the non-standard XFORWARD command when the Postfix SMTP server EHLO response announces XFORWARD support. </p> <p> This allows an "smtp" delivery agent, used for injecting mail into a content filter, to forward the name, address, protocol and HELO name of the original client to the content filter and downstream queuing SMTP server. This can produce more useful logging than localhost[127.0.0.1] etc. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_sender_dependent_authentication">smtp_sender_dependent_authentication</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable sender-dependent authentication in the Postfix SMTP client; this is available only with SASL authentication, and disables SMTP connection caching to ensure that mail from different senders will use the appropriate credentials. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_skip_4xx_greeting">smtp_skip_4xx_greeting</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Skip SMTP servers that greet with a 4XX status code (go away, try again later). </p> <p> By default, Postfix moves on the next mail exchanger. Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_skip_4xx_greeting">smtp_skip_4xx_greeting</a> = no" if Postfix should defer delivery immediately. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and earlier. Later Postfix versions always skip SMTP servers that greet with a 4XX status code. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_skip_5xx_greeting">smtp_skip_5xx_greeting</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Skip SMTP servers that greet with a 5XX status code (go away, do not try again later). </p> <p> By default, the Postfix SMTP client moves on the next mail exchanger. Specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_skip_5xx_greeting">smtp_skip_5xx_greeting</a> = no" if Postfix should bounce the mail immediately. The default setting is incorrect, but it is what a lot of people expect to happen. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_skip_quit_response">smtp_skip_quit_response</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Do not wait for the response to the SMTP QUIT command. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_starttls_timeout">smtp_starttls_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> Time limit for Postfix SMTP client write and read operations during TLS startup and shutdown handshake procedures. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_CAfile">smtp_tls_CAfile</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The file with the certificate of the certification authority (CA) that issued the Postfix SMTP client certificate. This is needed only when the CA certificate is not already present in the client certificate file. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_CAfile">smtp_tls_CAfile</a> = /etc/postfix/CAcert.pem </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_CApath">smtp_tls_CApath</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Directory with PEM format certificate authority certificates that the Postfix SMTP client uses to verify a remote SMTP server certificate. Don't forget to create the necessary "hash" links with, for example, "$OPENSSL_HOME/bin/c_rehash /etc/postfix/certs". </p> <p> To use this option in chroot mode, this directory (or a copy) must be inside the chroot jail. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_CApath">smtp_tls_CApath</a> = /etc/postfix/certs </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with the Postfix SMTP client RSA certificate in PEM format. This file may also contain the Postfix SMTP client private RSA key, and these may be the same as the Postfix SMTP server RSA certificate and key file. </p> <p> Do not configure client certificates unless you <b>must</b> present client TLS certificates to one or more servers. Client certificates are not usually needed, and can cause problems in configurations that work well without them. The recommended setting is to let the defaults stand: </p> <blockquote> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_dcert_file">smtp_tls_dcert_file</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_key_file">smtp_tls_key_file</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_dkey_file">smtp_tls_dkey_file</a> = </pre> </blockquote> <p> The best way to use the default settings is to comment out the above parameters in <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> if present. </p> <p> In order to verify certificates, the CA certificate (in case of a certificate chain, all CA certificates) must be available. You should add these certificates to the client certificate, the client certificate first, then the issuing CA(s). </p> <p> Example: the certificate for "client.dom.ain" was issued by "intermediate CA" which itself has a certificate of "root CA". Create the client.pem file with "cat client_cert.pem intermediate_CA.pem root_CA.pem > client.pem". </p> <p> If you also want to verify remote SMTP server certificates issued by these CAs, you can also add the CA certificates to the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_CAfile">smtp_tls_CAfile</a>, in which case it is not necessary to have them in the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_dcert_file">smtp_tls_dcert_file</a>. </p> <p> A certificate supplied here must be usable as an SSL client certificate and hence pass the "openssl verify -purpose sslclient ..." test. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a> = /etc/postfix/client.pem </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_cipherlist">smtp_tls_cipherlist</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Obsolete Postfix < 2.3 control for the Postfix SMTP client TLS cipher list. As this feature applies to all TLS security levels, it is easy to create inter-operability problems by choosing a non-default cipher list. Do not use a non-default TLS cipher list on hosts that deliver email to the public Internet: you will be unable to send email to servers that only support the ciphers you exclude. Using a restricted cipher list may be more appropriate for an internal MTA, where one can exert some control over the TLS software and settings of the peer servers. </p> <p> <b>Note:</b> do not use "" quotes around the parameter value. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix version 2.2. It is not used with Postfix 2.3 and later; use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_dcert_file">smtp_tls_dcert_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with the Postfix SMTP client DSA certificate in PEM format. This file may also contain the Postfix SMTP client private DSA key. </p> <p> See the discussion under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a> for more details. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_dcert_file">smtp_tls_dcert_file</a> = /etc/postfix/client-dsa.pem </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_dkey_file">smtp_tls_dkey_file</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_dcert_file">smtp_tls_dcert_file</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with the Postfix SMTP client DSA private key in PEM format. This file may be combined with the Postfix SMTP client DSA certificate file specified with $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_dcert_file">smtp_tls_dcert_file</a>. </p> <p> The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted, but file permissions should grant read/write access only to the system superuser account ("root"). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_enforce_peername">smtp_tls_enforce_peername</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> With mandatory TLS encryption, require that the remote SMTP server hostname matches the information in the remote SMTP server certificate. As of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc2487.html">RFC 2487</a> the requirements for hostname checking for MTA clients are not specified. </p> <p> This option can be set to "no" to disable strict peer name checking. This setting has no effect on sessions that are controlled via the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_per_site">smtp_tls_per_site</a> table. </p> <p> Disabling the hostname verification can make sense in closed environment where special CAs are created. If not used carefully, this option opens the danger of a "man-in-the-middle" attack (the CommonName of this attacker will be logged). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3 and later use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> List of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the Postfix SMTP client cipher list at all TLS security levels. This is not an OpenSSL cipherlist, it is a simple list separated by whitespace and/or commas. The elements are a single cipher, or one or more "+" separated cipher properties, in which case only ciphers matching <b>all</b> the properties are excluded. </p> <p> Examples (some of these will cause problems): </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = MD5, DES <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = DES+MD5 <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = AES256-SHA, DES-CBC3-MD5 <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = kEDH+aRSA </pre> <p> The first setting, disables anonymous ciphers. The next setting disables ciphers that use the MD5 digest algorithm or the (single) DES encryption algorithm. The next setting disables ciphers that use MD5 and DES together. The next setting disables the two ciphers "AES256-SHA" and "DES-CBC3-MD5". The last setting disables ciphers that use "EDH" key exchange with RSA authentication. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_key_file">smtp_tls_key_file</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with the Postfix SMTP client RSA private key in PEM format. This file may be combined with the Postfix SMTP client RSA certificate file specified with $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a>. </p> <p> The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted, but file permissions should grant read/write access only to the system superuser account ("root"). </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_key_file">smtp_tls_key_file</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_cert_file">smtp_tls_cert_file</a> </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_loglevel">smtp_tls_loglevel</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable additional Postfix SMTP client logging of TLS activity. Each logging level also includes the information that is logged at a lower logging level. </p> <dl compact> <dt> </dt> <dd> 0 Disable logging of TLS activity. </dd> <dt> </dt> <dd> 1 Log TLS handshake and certificate information. </dd> <dt> </dt> <dd> 2 Log levels during TLS negotiation. </dd> <dt> </dt> <dd> 3 Log hexadecimal and ASCII dump of TLS negotiation process. </dd> <dt> </dt> <dd> 4 Log hexadecimal and ASCII dump of complete transmission after STARTTLS. </dd> </dl> <p> Use "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_loglevel">smtp_tls_loglevel</a> = 3" only in case of problems. Use of loglevel 4 is strongly discouraged. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> (default: medium)</b></DT><DD> <p> The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix SMTP client will use with mandatory TLS encryption. The default value "medium" is suitable for most destinations with which you may want to enforce TLS, and is beyond the reach of today's crypt-analytic methods. See <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a> for information on how to configure ciphers on a per-destination basis. </p> <p> The following cipher grades are supported: </p> <dl> <dt><b>export</b></dt> <dd> Enable the mainstream "EXPORT" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers. This is always used for opportunistic encryption. It is not recommended for mandatory encryption unless you must enforce TLS with "crippled" peers. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_export_cipherlist">tls_export_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_export_cipherlist">tls_export_cipherlist</a> includes anonymous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the client is configured to verify server certificates. If you must exclude anonymous ciphers also at the "encrypt" security level, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". </dd> <dt><b>low</b></dt> <dd> Enable the mainstream "LOW" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers. This setting is only appropriate for internal mail servers. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_low_cipherlist">tls_low_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_low_cipherlist">tls_low_cipherlist</a> includes anonymous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the client is configured to verify server certificates. If you must exclude anonymous ciphers also at the "encrypt" security level, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". </dd> <dt><b>medium</b></dt> <dd> Enable the mainstream "MEDIUM" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_medium_cipherlist">tls_medium_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_medium_cipherlist">tls_medium_cipherlist</a> includes anonymous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the client is configured to verify server certificates. If you must exclude anonymous ciphers also at the "encrypt" security level, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". </dd> <dt><b>high</b></dt> <dd> Enable only the mainstream "HIGH" grade OpenSSL ciphers. This setting is appropriate when all mandatory TLS destinations support some of "HIGH" grade ciphers, this is not uncommon. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_high_cipherlist">tls_high_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_high_cipherlist">tls_high_cipherlist</a> includes anonymous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the client is configured to verify server certificates. If you must exclude anonymous ciphers also at the "encrypt" security level, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". </dd> <dt><b>null</b></dt> <dd> Enable only the "NULL" OpenSSL ciphers, these provide authentication without encryption. This setting is only appropriate in the rare case that all servers are prepared to use NULL ciphers (not normally enabled in TLS servers). A plausible use-case is an LMTP server listening on a UNIX-domain socket that is configured to support "NULL" ciphers. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_null_cipherlist">tls_null_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_null_cipherlist">tls_null_cipherlist</a> excludes anonymous ciphers (OpenSSL 0.9.8 has NULL ciphers that offer data integrity without encryption or authentication). </dd> </dl> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Additional list of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the SMTP client cipher list at mandatory TLS security levels. This list works in addition to the exclusions listed with <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> (see there for syntax details). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> (default: SSLv3, TLSv1)</b></DT><DD> <p> List of TLS protocols that the Postfix SMTP client will use with mandatory TLS encryption. In <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> the values are separated by whitespace, commas or colons. In the policy table (see <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a>) the only valid separator is colon. An empty value means allow all protocols. The valid protocol names, (see <b>SSL_get_version(3)</b>), are "SSLv2", "SSLv3" and "TLSv1". </p> <p> Since SSL version 2 has known protocol weaknesses and is now deprecated, the default setting only lists "SSLv3" and "TLSv1". This means that by default, SSL version 2 will not be used at the "encrypt" security level and higher. </p> <p> See the documentation of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a> parameter and <a href="TLS_README.html">TLS_README</a> for more information about security levels. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer">smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Log the hostname of a remote SMTP server that offers STARTTLS, when TLS is not already enabled for that server. </p> <p> The logfile record looks like: </p> <pre> postfix/smtp[pid]: Host offered STARTTLS: [name.of.host] </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_per_site">smtp_tls_per_site</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with the Postfix SMTP client TLS usage policy by next-hop destination and by remote SMTP server hostname. When both lookups succeed, the more specific per-site policy (NONE, MUST, etc) overrides the less specific one (MAY), and the more secure per-site policy (MUST, etc) overrides the less secure one (NONE). With Postfix 2.3 and later <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_per_site">smtp_tls_per_site</a> is strongly discouraged: use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a> instead. </p> <p> Use of the bare hostname as the per-site table lookup key is discouraged. Always use the full destination nexthop (enclosed in [] with a possible ":port" suffix). A recipient domain or MX-enabled transport next-hop with no port suffix may look like a bare hostname, but is still a suitable <i>destination</i>. </p> <p> Specify a next-hop destination or server hostname on the left-hand side; no wildcards are allowed. The next-hop destination is either the recipient domain, or the destination specified with a <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table, the <a href="postconf.5.html#relayhost">relayhost</a> parameter, or the <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a> parameter. On the right hand side specify one of the following keywords: </p> <dl> <dt> NONE </dt> <dd> Don't use TLS at all. This overrides a less specific <b>MAY</b> lookup result from the alternate host or next-hop lookup key, and overrides the global <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_use_tls">smtp_use_tls</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_enforce_tls">smtp_enforce_tls</a>, and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_enforce_peername">smtp_tls_enforce_peername</a> settings. </dd> <dt> MAY </dt> <dd> Try to use TLS if the server announces support, otherwise use the unencrypted connection. This has less precedence than a more specific result (including <b>NONE</b>) from the alternate host or next-hop lookup key, and has less precedence than the more specific global "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_enforce_tls">smtp_enforce_tls</a> = yes" or "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_enforce_peername">smtp_tls_enforce_peername</a> = yes". </dd> <dt> MUST_NOPEERMATCH </dt> <dd> Require TLS encryption, but do not require that the remote SMTP server hostname matches the information in the remote SMTP server certificate, or that the server certificate was issued by a trusted CA. This overrides a less secure <b>NONE</b> or a less specific <b>MAY</b> lookup result from the alternate host or next-hop lookup key, and overrides the global <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_use_tls">smtp_use_tls</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_enforce_tls">smtp_enforce_tls</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_enforce_peername">smtp_tls_enforce_peername</a> settings. </dd> <dt> MUST </dt> <dd> Require TLS encryption, require that the remote SMTP server hostname matches the information in the remote SMTP server certificate, and require that the remote SMTP server certificate was issued by a trusted CA. This overrides a less secure <b>NONE</b> and <b>MUST_NOPEERMATCH</b> or a less specific <b>MAY</b> lookup result from the alternate host or next-hop lookup key, and overrides the global <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_use_tls">smtp_use_tls</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_enforce_tls">smtp_enforce_tls</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_enforce_peername">smtp_tls_enforce_peername</a> settings. </dd> </dl> <p> The above keywords correspond to the "none", "may", "encrypt" and "verify" security levels for the new <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> parameter introduced in Postfix 2.3. Starting with Postfix 2.3, and independently of how the policy is specified, the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> parameters only apply when TLS encryption is mandatory. Connections for which encryption is optional enable all "export" grade and better ciphers. </p> <p> As long as no secure DNS lookup mechanism is available, false hostnames in MX or CNAME responses can change the server hostname that Postfix uses for TLS policy lookup and server certificate verification. Even with a perfect match between the server hostname and the server certificate, there is no guarantee that Postfix is connected to the right server. See <a href="TLS_README.html">TLS_README</a> (Closing a DNS loophole with obsolete per-site TLS policies) for a possible work-around. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3 and later use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a> instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with the Postfix SMTP client TLS security policy by next-hop destination; when a non-empty value is specified, this overrides the obsolete <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_per_site">smtp_tls_per_site</a> parameter. See <a href="TLS_README.html">TLS_README</a> for a more detailed discussion of TLS security levels. </p> <p> The TLS policy table is indexed by the full next-hop destination, which is either the recipient domain, or the verbatim next-hop specified in the transport table, $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_transport">local_transport</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_transport">virtual_transport</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_transport">relay_transport</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_transport">default_transport</a>. This includes any enclosing square brackets and any non-default destination server port suffix. The LMTP socket type prefix (inet: or unix:) is not included in the lookup key. </p> <p> Only the next-hop domain, or $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> with LMTP over UNIX-domain sockets, is used as the nexthop name for certificate verification. The port and any enclosing square brackets are used in the table lookup key, but are not used for server name verification. </p> <p> When the lookup key is a domain name without enclosing square brackets or any <i>:port</i> suffix (typically the recipient domain), and the full domain is not found in the table, just as with the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table, the parent domain starting with a leading "." is matched recursively. This allows one to specify a security policy for a recipient domain and all its sub-domains. </p> <p> The lookup result is a security level, followed by an optional list of whitespace and/or comma separated name=value attributes that override related <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> settings. The TLS security levels in order of increasing security are: </p> <dl> <dt><b>none</b></dt> <dd>No TLS. No additional attributes are supported at this level. </dd> <dt><b>may</b></dt> <dd>Opportunistic TLS. No additional attributes are supported at this level. Since sending in the clear is acceptable, demanding stronger than default TLS security parameters merely reduces inter-operability. Postfix 2.3 and later ignore the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> parameters at this security level; all protocols are allowed and "export" grade or better ciphers are used. When TLS handshakes fail, the connection is retried with TLS disabled. This allows mail delivery to sites with non-interoperable TLS implementations.</dd> <dt><b>encrypt</b></dt> <dd>Mandatory TLS encryption. At this level and higher the optional "ciphers" attribute overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> parameter and the optional "protocols" keyword overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> parameter. In the policy table, multiple protocols must be separated by colons, as attribute values may not contain whitespace or commas. </dd> <dt><b>verify</b></dt> <dd>Mandatory TLS verification. At this security level, DNS MX lookups are trusted to be secure enough, and the name verified in the server certificate is usually obtained indirectly via unauthenticated DNS MX lookups. The optional "match" attribute overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_verify_cert_match">smtp_tls_verify_cert_match</a> parameter. In the policy table, multiple match patterns and strategies must be separated by colons. In practice explicit control over matching is more common with the "secure" policy, described below. </dd> <dt><b>secure</b></dt> <dd>Secure-channel TLS. At this security level, DNS MX lookups, though potentially used to determine the candidate next-hop gateway IP addresses, are <b>not</b> trusted to be secure enough for TLS peername verification. Instead, the default name verified in the server certificate is obtained directly from the next-hop, or is explicitly specified via the optional <b>match</b> attribute which overrides the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_secure_cert_match">smtp_tls_secure_cert_match</a> parameter. In the policy table, multiple match patterns and strategies must be separated by colons. The match attribute is most useful when multiple domains are supported by common server, the policy entries for additional domains specify matching rules for the primary domain certificate. While transport table overrides routing the secondary domains to the primary nexthop also allow secure verification, they risk delivery to the wrong destination when domains change hands or are re-assigned to new gateways. With the "match" attribute approach, routing is not perturbed, and mail is deferred if verification of a new MX host fails. </dd> </dl> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a>: <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/tls_policy </pre> <pre> tls_policy: example.edu none example.mil may example.gov encrypt protocols=TLSv1 example.com verify ciphers=high example.net secure .example.net secure match=.example.net:example.net [mail.example.org]:587 secure match=nexthop </pre> <p> <b>Note:</b> The <b>hostname</b> strategy if listed in a non-default setting of <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_secure_cert_match">smtp_tls_secure_cert_match</a> or in the <b>match</b> attribute in the policy table can render the <b>secure</b> level vulnerable to DNS forgery. Do not use the <b>hostname</b> strategy for secure-channel configurations in environments where DNS security is not assured. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth">smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth</a> (default: 5)</b></DT><DD> <p> The verification depth for remote SMTP server certificates. A depth of 1 is sufficient, if the certificate is directly issued by a CA listed in the CA files. The default value (5) should suffice for longer chains (the root CA issues special CA which then issues the actual certificate...). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_secure_cert_match">smtp_tls_secure_cert_match</a> (default: nexthop, dot-nexthop)</b></DT><DD> <p> The server certificate peername verification method for the "secure" TLS security level. In a "secure" TLS policy table ($<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a>) entry the optional "match" attribute overrides this <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> setting. </p> <p> This parameter specifies one or more patterns or strategies separated by commas, whitespace or colons. In the policy table the only valid separator is the colon character. </p> <p> For a description of the pattern and strategy syntax see the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_verify_cert_match">smtp_tls_verify_cert_match</a> parameter. The "hostname" strategy should be avoided in this context, as in the absence of a secure global DNS, using the results of MX lookups in certificate verification is not immune to active (man-in-the-middle) attacks on DNS. </p> <p> Sample <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> setting: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_secure_cert_match">smtp_tls_secure_cert_match</a> = nexthop </pre> <p> Sample policy table override: </p> <pre> example.net secure match=example.com:.example.com .example.net secure match=example.com:.example.com </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default SMTP TLS security level for the Postfix SMTP client; when a non-empty value is specified, this overrides the obsolete parameters <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_use_tls">smtp_use_tls</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_enforce_tls">smtp_enforce_tls</a>, and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_enforce_peername">smtp_tls_enforce_peername</a>. </p> <p> Specify one of the following security levels: </p> <dl> <dt><b>none</b></dt> <dd> TLS will not be used unless enabled for specific destinations via <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a>. </dd> <dt><b>may</b></dt> <dd> Opportunistic TLS. TLS will be used if supported by the server. Since sending in the clear is acceptable, demanding stronger than default TLS security parameters merely reduces inter-operability. Postfix 2.3 and later ignore the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> parameters at this security level; all protocols are allowed and "export" grade or better ciphers are used. When TLS handshakes fail, the connection is retried with TLS disabled. This allows mail delivery to sites with non-interoperable TLS implementations. </dd> <dt><b>encrypt</b></dt> <dd>Mandatory TLS encryption. Since a minimum level of security is intended, it reasonable to be specific about sufficiently secure protocol versions and ciphers. At this security level and higher, the <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> parameters <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> specify the TLS protocols and minimum cipher grade which the administrator considers secure enough for mandatory encrypted sessions. This security level is not an appropriate default for systems delivering mail to the Internet. </dd> <dt><b>verify</b></dt> <dd>Mandatory TLS verification. At this security level, DNS MX lookups are trusted to be secure enough, and the name verified in the server certificate is usually obtained indirectly via unauthenticated DNS MX lookups. The <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_verify_cert_match">smtp_tls_verify_cert_match</a> parameter controls how the server name is verified. In practice explicit control over matching is more common at the "secure" level, described below. This security level is not an appropriate default for systems delivering mail to the Internet. </dd> <dt><b>secure</b></dt> <dd>Secure-channel TLS. At this security level, DNS MX lookups, though potentially used to determine the candidate next-hop gateway IP addresses, are <b>not</b> trusted to be secure enough for TLS peername verification. Instead, the default name verified in the server certificate is obtained from the next-hop domain as specified in the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_secure_cert_match">smtp_tls_secure_cert_match</a> configuration parameter. The default matching rule is that a server certificate matches when its name is equal to or is a sub-domain of the nexthop domain. This security level is not an appropriate default for systems delivering mail to the Internet. </dd> </dl> <p> Examples: </p> <p>No TLS, old-style: <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_use_tls">smtp_use_tls</a>=no and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_enforce_tls">smtp_enforce_tls</a>=no.</p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a>: <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> = none </pre> <p>Opportunistic TLS:</p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a>: <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> = may </pre> <p>Mandatory (high-grade) TLS encryption:</p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a>: <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> = encrypt <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> = high </pre> <p>Mandatory TLS verification, of hostname or nexthop domain:</p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a>: <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> = verify <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> = high <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_verify_cert_match">smtp_tls_verify_cert_match</a> = hostname, nexthop, dot-nexthop </pre> <p>Secure channel TLS with exact nexthop name matching:</p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a>: <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> = secure <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> = TLSv1 <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> = high <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_secure_cert_match">smtp_tls_secure_cert_match</a> = nexthop </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_session_cache_database">smtp_tls_session_cache_database</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Name of the file containing the optional Postfix SMTP client TLS session cache. Specify a database type that supports enumeration, such as <b>btree</b> or <b>sdbm</b>; there is no need to support concurrent access. The file is created if it does not exist. The <a href="smtp.8.html">smtp(8)</a> daemon does not use this parameter directly, rather the cache is implemented indirectly in the <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> daemon. This means that per-smtp-instance <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> overrides of this parameter are not effective. Note, that each of the cache databases supported by <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> daemon: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_session_cache_database">smtpd_tls_session_cache_database</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_session_cache_database">smtp_tls_session_cache_database</a> (and with Postfix 2.3 and later $lmtp_session_cache_database), needs to be stored separately, it is not at this time possible to store multiple caches in a single database. </p> <p> Note: <b>dbm</b> databases are not suitable. TLS session objects are too large. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_session_cache_database">smtp_tls_session_cache_database</a> = btree:/var/spool/postfix/smtp_scache </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout">smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout</a> (default: 3600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The expiration time of Postfix SMTP client TLS session cache information. A cache cleanup is performed periodically every $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout">smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout</a> seconds. As with $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_session_cache_database">smtp_tls_session_cache_database</a>, this parameter is implemented in the <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> daemon and therefore per-smtp-instance <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> overrides are not possible. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_tls_verify_cert_match">smtp_tls_verify_cert_match</a> (default: hostname)</b></DT><DD> <p> The server certificate peername verification method for the "verify" TLS security level. In a "verify" TLS policy table ($<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_policy_maps">smtp_tls_policy_maps</a>) entry the optional "match" attribute overrides this <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> setting. </p> <p> This parameter specifies one or more patterns or strategies separated by commas, whitespace or colons. In the policy table the only valid separator is the colon character. </p> <p> Patterns specify domain names, or domain name suffixes: </p> <dl> <dt><i>example.com</i></dt> <dd> Match the <i>example.com</i> domain, i.e. one of the names the server certificate must be <i>example.com</i>, upper and lower case distinctions are ignored. </dd> <dt><i>.example.com</i></dt> <dd> Match subdomains of the <i>example.com</i> domain, i.e. match a name in the server certificate that consists of a non-zero number of labels followed by a <i>.example.com</i> suffix. Case distinctions are ignored.</dd> </dl> <p> Strategies specify a transformation from the next-hop domain to the expected name in the server certificate: </p> <dl> <dt>nexthop</dt> <dd> Match against the next-hop domain, which is either the recipient domain, or the transport next-hop configured for the domain stripped of any optional socket type prefix, enclosing square brackets and trailing port. When MX lookups are not suppressed, this is the original nexthop domain prior to the MX lookup, not the result of the MX lookup. For LMTP delivery via UNIX-domain sockets, the verified next-hop name is $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>. This strategy is suitable for use with the "secure" policy. Case is ignored.</dd> <dt>dot-nexthop</dt> <dd> As above, but match server certificate names that are subdomains of the next-hop domain. Case is ignored.</dd> <dt>hostname</dt> <dd> Match against the hostname of the server, often obtained via an unauthenticated DNS MX lookup. For LMTP delivery via UNIX-domain sockets, the verified name is $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>. This matches the verification strategy of the "MUST" keyword in the obsolete <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_per_site">smtp_tls_per_site</a> table, and is suitable for use with the "verify" security level. When the next-hop name is enclosed in square brackets to suppress MX lookups, the "hostname" strategy is the same as the "nexthop" strategy. Case is ignored.</dd> </dl> <p> Sample <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> setting: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_verify_cert_match">smtp_tls_verify_cert_match</a> = hostname, nexthop, dot-nexthop </pre> <p> Sample policy table override: </p> <pre> example.com verify match=hostname:nexthop .example.com verify match=example.com:.example.com:hostname </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_use_tls">smtp_use_tls</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Opportunistic mode: use TLS when a remote SMTP server announces STARTTLS support, otherwise send the mail in the clear. Beware: some SMTP servers offer STARTTLS even if it is not configured. With Postfix < 2.3, if the TLS handshake fails, and no other server is available, delivery is deferred and mail stays in the queue. If this is a concern for you, use the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_per_site">smtp_tls_per_site</a> feature instead. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3 and later use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_security_level">smtp_tls_security_level</a> instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtp_xforward_timeout">smtp_xforward_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP client time limit for sending the XFORWARD command, and for receiving the server response. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_authorized_verp_clients">smtpd_authorized_verp_clients</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#authorized_verp_clients">authorized_verp_clients</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> What SMTP clients are allowed to specify the XVERP command. This command requests that mail be delivered one recipient at a time with a per recipient return address. </p> <p> By default, no clients are allowed to specify XVERP. </p> <p> This parameter was renamed with Postfix version 2.1. The default value is backwards compatible with Postfix version 2.0. </p> <p> Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it), "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside <tt>[]</tt> in the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_authorized_verp_clients">smtpd_authorized_verp_clients</a> value, and in files specified with "/file/name". IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be confused with a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" pattern. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts">smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> What SMTP clients are allowed to use the XCLIENT feature. This command overrides SMTP client information that is used for access control. Typical use is for SMTP-based content filters, fetchmail-like programs, or SMTP server access rule testing. See the <a href="XCLIENT_README.html">XCLIENT_README</a> document for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> <p> By default, no clients are allowed to specify XCLIENT. </p> <p> Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it), "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside <tt>[]</tt> in the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts">smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts</a> value, and in files specified with "/file/name". IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be confused with a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" pattern. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_authorized_xforward_hosts">smtpd_authorized_xforward_hosts</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> What SMTP clients are allowed to use the XFORWARD feature. This command forwards information that is used to improve logging after SMTP-based content filters. See the <a href="XFORWARD_README.html">XFORWARD_README</a> document for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> <p> By default, no clients are allowed to specify XFORWARD. </p> <p> Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it), "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside <tt>[]</tt> in the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_authorized_xforward_hosts">smtpd_authorized_xforward_hosts</a> value, and in files specified with "/file/name". IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be confused with a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" pattern. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_banner">smtpd_banner</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> ESMTP $<a href="postconf.5.html#mail_name">mail_name</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The text that follows the 220 status code in the SMTP greeting banner. Some people like to see the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version. </p> <p> You MUST specify $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> at the start of the text. This is required by the SMTP protocol. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_banner">smtpd_banner</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> ESMTP $<a href="postconf.5.html#mail_name">mail_name</a> ($<a href="postconf.5.html#mail_version">mail_version</a>) </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_client_connection_count_limit">smtpd_client_connection_count_limit</a> (default: 50)</b></DT><DD> <p> How many simultaneous connections any client is allowed to make to this service. By default, the limit is set to half the default process limit value. </p> <p> To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0. </p> <p> WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate legitimate mail traffic. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_client_connection_rate_limit">smtpd_client_connection_rate_limit</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of connection attempts any client is allowed to make to this service per time unit. The time unit is specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#anvil_rate_time_unit">anvil_rate_time_unit</a> configuration parameter. </p> <p> By default, a client can make as many connections per time unit as Postfix can accept. </p> <p> To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0. </p> <p> WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate legitimate mail traffic. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_connection_rate_limit">smtpd_client_connection_rate_limit</a> = 1000 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions">smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Clients that are excluded from connection count, connection rate, or SMTP request rate restrictions. See the <a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> parameter description for the parameter value syntax. </p> <p> By default, clients in trusted networks are excluded. Specify a list of network blocks, hostnames or .domain names (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it). </p> <p> Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside <tt>[]</tt> in the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions">smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions</a> value, and in files specified with "/file/name". IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be confused with a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" pattern. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_client_message_rate_limit">smtpd_client_message_rate_limit</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of message delivery requests that any client is allowed to make to this service per time unit, regardless of whether or not Postfix actually accepts those messages. The time unit is specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#anvil_rate_time_unit">anvil_rate_time_unit</a> configuration parameter. </p> <p> By default, a client can send as many message delivery requests per time unit as Postfix can accept. </p> <p> To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0. </p> <p> WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate legitimate mail traffic. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_message_rate_limit">smtpd_client_message_rate_limit</a> = 1000 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_client_new_tls_session_rate_limit">smtpd_client_new_tls_session_rate_limit</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of new (i.e., uncached) TLS sessions that a remote SMTP client is allowed to negotiate with this service per time unit. The time unit is specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#anvil_rate_time_unit">anvil_rate_time_unit</a> configuration parameter. </p> <p> By default, a remote SMTP client can negotiate as many new TLS sessions per time unit as Postfix can accept. </p> <p> To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0. Otherwise, specify a limit that is at least the per-client concurrent session limit, or else legitimate client sessions may be rejected. </p> <p> WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate legitimate mail traffic. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_new_tls_session_rate_limit">smtpd_client_new_tls_session_rate_limit</a> = 100 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_client_recipient_rate_limit">smtpd_client_recipient_rate_limit</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipient addresses that any client is allowed to send to this service per time unit, regardless of whether or not Postfix actually accepts those recipients. The time unit is specified with the <a href="postconf.5.html#anvil_rate_time_unit">anvil_rate_time_unit</a> configuration parameter. </p> <p> By default, a client can make as many recipient addresses per time unit as Postfix can accept. </p> <p> To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0. </p> <p> WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate legitimate mail traffic. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_recipient_rate_limit">smtpd_client_recipient_rate_limit</a> = 1000 </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional SMTP server access restrictions in the context of a client SMTP connection request. </p> <p> The default is to allow all connection requests. </p> <p> Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction that matches wins. </p> <p> The following restrictions are specific to client hostname or client network address information. </p> <dl> <dt><b><a name="check_ccert_access">check_ccert_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd> Use the client certificate fingerprint as lookup key for the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database; with Postfix version 2.2, also require that the SMTP client certificate is verified successfully. This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2 and later.</dd> <dt><b><a name="check_client_access">check_client_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified access database for the client hostname, parent domains, client IP address, or networks obtained by stripping least significant octets. See the <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> manual page for details. </dd> <dt><b><a name="permit_inet_interfaces">permit_inet_interfaces</a></b></dt> <dd>Permit the request when the client IP address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a>. </dd> <dt><b><a name="permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a></b></dt> <dd>Permit the request when the client IP address matches any network or network address listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a>. </dd> <dt><b><a name="permit_sasl_authenticated">permit_sasl_authenticated</a></b></dt> <dd> Permit the request when the client is successfully authenticated via the <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc2554.html">RFC 2554</a> (AUTH) protocol. </dd> <dt><b><a name="permit_tls_all_clientcerts">permit_tls_all_clientcerts</a></b></dt> <dd> Permit the request when the remote SMTP client certificate is verified successfully. This option must be used only if a special CA issues the certificates and only this CA is listed as trusted CA, otherwise all clients with a recognized certificate would be allowed to relay. This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.</dd> <dt><b><a name="permit_tls_clientcerts">permit_tls_clientcerts</a></b></dt> <dd>Permit the request when the remote SMTP client certificate is verified successfully, and the certificate fingerprint is listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_clientcerts">relay_clientcerts</a>. This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_rbl_client">reject_rbl_client <i>rbl_domain=d.d.d.d</i></a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the reversed client network address is listed with the A record "<i>d.d.d.d</i>" under <i>rbl_domain</i> (Postfix version 2.1 and later only). If no "<i>=d.d.d.d</i>" is specified, reject the request when the reversed client network address is listed with any A record under <i>rbl_domain</i>. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#maps_rbl_reject_code">maps_rbl_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 554), the <a href="postconf.5.html#default_rbl_reply">default_rbl_reply</a> parameter specifies the default server reply, and the <a href="postconf.5.html#rbl_reply_maps">rbl_reply_maps</a> parameter specifies tables with server replies indexed by <i>rbl_domain</i>. This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_rhsbl_client">reject_rhsbl_client <i>rbl_domain=d.d.d.d</i></a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the client hostname is listed with the A record "<i>d.d.d.d</i>" under <i>rbl_domain</i> (Postfix version 2.1 and later only). If no "<i>=d.d.d.d</i>" is specified, reject the request when the client hostname is listed with any A record under <i>rbl_domain</i>. See the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_rbl_client">reject_rbl_client</a> description above for additional RBL related configuration parameters. This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unknown_client_hostname">reject_unknown_client_hostname</a></b> (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_unknown_client)</dt> <dd>Reject the request when 1) the client IP address->name mapping fails, 2) the name->address mapping fails, or 3) the name->address mapping does not match the client IP address. <br> This is a stronger restriction than the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname">reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname</a> feature, which triggers only under condition 1) above. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#unknown_client_reject_code">unknown_client_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 450). The reply is always 450 in case the address->name or name->address lookup failed due to a temporary problem. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname">reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the client IP address has no address->name mapping. <br> This is a weaker restriction than the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_client_hostname">reject_unknown_client_hostname</a> feature, which requires not only that the address->name and name->address mappings exist, but also that the two mappings reproduce the client IP address. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#unknown_client_reject_code">unknown_client_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 450). The reply is always 450 in case the address->name lookup failed due to a temporary problem. <br> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </dd> </dl> <p> In addition, you can use any of the following <a name="generic"> generic</a> restrictions. These restrictions are applicable in any SMTP command context. </p> <dl> <dt><b><a name="check_policy_service">check_policy_service <i>servername</i></a></b></dt> <dd>Query the specified policy server. See the <a href="SMTPD_POLICY_README.html">SMTPD_POLICY_README</a> document for details. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="defer">defer</a></b></dt> <dd>Defer the request. The client is told to try again later. This restriction is useful at the end of a restriction list, to make the default policy explicit. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#defer_code">defer_code</a> parameter specifies the SMTP server reply code (default: 450).</dd> <dt><b><a name="defer_if_permit">defer_if_permit</a></b></dt> <dd>Defer the request if some later restriction would result in an explicit or implicit PERMIT action. This is useful when a blacklisting feature fails due to a temporary problem. This feature is available in Postfix version 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="defer_if_reject">defer_if_reject</a></b></dt> <dd>Defer the request if some later restriction would result in a REJECT action. This is useful when a whitelisting feature fails due to a temporary problem. This feature is available in Postfix version 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="permit">permit</a></b></dt> <dd>Permit the request. This restriction is useful at the end of a restriction list, to make the default policy explicit.</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_multi_recipient_bounce">reject_multi_recipient_bounce</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the envelope sender is the null address, and the message has multiple envelope recipients. This usage has rare but legitimate applications: under certain conditions, multi-recipient mail that was posted with the DSN option NOTIFY=NEVER may be forwarded with the null sender address. <br> Note: this restriction can only work reliably when used in <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_data_restrictions">smtpd_data_restrictions</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_end_of_data_restrictions">smtpd_end_of_data_restrictions</a>, because the total number of recipients is not known at an earlier stage of the SMTP conversation. Use at the RCPT stage will only reject the second etc. recipient. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#multi_recipient_bounce_reject_code">multi_recipient_bounce_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 550). This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_plaintext_session">reject_plaintext_session</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the connection is not encrypted. This restriction should not be used before the client has had a chance to negotiate encryption with the AUTH or STARTTLS commands. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#plaintext_reject_code">plaintext_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 450). This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unauth_pipelining">reject_unauth_pipelining</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the client sends SMTP commands ahead of time where it is not allowed, or when the client sends SMTP commands ahead of time without knowing that Postfix actually supports ESMTP command pipelining. This stops mail from bulk mail software that improperly uses ESMTP command pipelining in order to speed up deliveries. <br> Note: <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_pipelining">reject_unauth_pipelining</a> is not useful outside <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_data_restrictions">smtpd_data_restrictions</a> when 1) the client uses ESMTP (EHLO instead of HELO) and 2) with "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_delay_reject">smtpd_delay_reject</a> = yes" (the default). The use of <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_pipelining">reject_unauth_pipelining</a> in the other restriction contexts is therefore not recommended. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject">reject</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request. This restriction is useful at the end of a restriction list, to make the default policy explicit. The <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_code">reject_code</a> configuration parameter specifies the response code to rejected requests (default: 554).</dd> <dt><b><a name="sleep">sleep <i>seconds</i></a></b></dt> <dd>Pause for the specified number of seconds and proceed with the next restriction in the list, if any. This may stop zombie mail when used as: <pre> /etc/postfix/<a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a>: <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a> = sleep 1, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_pipelining">reject_unauth_pipelining</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_delay_reject">smtpd_delay_reject</a> = no </pre> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3. </dd> <dt><b><a name="warn_if_reject">warn_if_reject</a></b></dt> <dd>Change the meaning of the next restriction, so that it logs a warning instead of rejecting a request (look for logfile records that contain "reject_warning"). This is useful for testing new restrictions in a "live" environment without risking unnecessary loss of mail. </dd> </dl> <p> Other restrictions that are valid in this context: </p> <ul> <li> SMTP command specific restrictions that are described under the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a> parameters. When helo, sender or recipient restrictions are listed under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>, they have effect only with "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_delay_reject">smtpd_delay_reject</a> = yes", so that $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a> is evaluated at the time of the RCPT TO command. </ul> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_client_hostname">reject_unknown_client_hostname</a> </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_data_restrictions">smtpd_data_restrictions</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional access restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of the SMTP DATA command. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> <p> Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction that matches wins. </p> <p> The following restrictions are valid in this context: </p> <ul> <li><a href="#generic">Generic</a> restrictions that can be used in any SMTP command context, described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>. <li>SMTP command specific restrictions described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a>. </ul> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_data_restrictions">smtpd_data_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_pipelining">reject_unauth_pipelining</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_data_restrictions">smtpd_data_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_multi_recipient_bounce">reject_multi_recipient_bounce</a> </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_delay_open_until_valid_rcpt">smtpd_delay_open_until_valid_rcpt</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Postpone the start of an SMTP mail transaction until a valid RCPT TO command is received. Specify "no" to create a mail transaction as soon as the SMTP server receives a valid MAIL FROM command. </p> <p> With sites that reject lots of mail, the default setting reduces the use of disk, CPU and memory resources. The downside is that rejected recipients are logged with NOQUEUE instead of a mail transaction ID. This complicates the logfile analysis of multi-recipient mail. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_delay_reject">smtpd_delay_reject</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Wait until the RCPT TO command before evaluating $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a> and $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a>, or wait until the ETRN command before evaluating $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a> and $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a>. </p> <p> This feature is turned on by default because some clients apparently mis-behave when the Postfix SMTP server rejects commands before RCPT TO. </p> <p> The default setting has one major benefit: it allows Postfix to log recipient address information when rejecting a client name/address or sender address, so that it is possible to find out whose mail is being rejected. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps">smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Lookup tables, indexed by the remote SMTP client address, with case insensitive lists of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the SMTP server will not send in the EHLO response to a remote SMTP client. See <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords">smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords</a> for details. The table is not searched by hostname for robustness reasons. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords">smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> A case insensitive list of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the SMTP server will not send in the EHLO response to a remote SMTP client. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> Notes: </p> <ul> <li> <p> Specify the <b>silent-discard</b> pseudo keyword to prevent this action from being logged. </p> <li> <p> Use the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps">smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps</a> feature to discard EHLO keywords selectively. </p> </ul> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_end_of_data_restrictions">smtpd_end_of_data_restrictions</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional access restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of the SMTP END-OF-DATA command. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> <p> See <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_data_restrictions">smtpd_data_restrictions</a> for syntax details. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_enforce_tls">smtpd_enforce_tls</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Mandatory TLS: announce STARTTLS support to SMTP clients, and require that clients use TLS encryption. According to <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc2487.html">RFC 2487</a> this MUST NOT be applied in case of a publicly-referenced SMTP server. This option is off by default and should be used only on dedicated servers. </p> <p> Note 1: "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_enforce_tls">smtpd_enforce_tls</a> = yes" implies "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_auth_only">smtpd_tls_auth_only</a> = yes". </p> <p> Note 2: when invoked via "<b>sendmail -bs</b>", Postfix will never offer STARTTLS due to insufficient privileges to access the server private key. This is intended behavior. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3 and later use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_security_level">smtpd_tls_security_level</a> instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_error_sleep_time">smtpd_error_sleep_time</a> (default: 1s)</b></DT><DD> <p>With Postfix version 2.1 and later: the SMTP server response delay after a client has made more than $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_soft_error_limit">smtpd_soft_error_limit</a> errors, and fewer than $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_hard_error_limit">smtpd_hard_error_limit</a> errors, without delivering mail. </p> <p>With Postfix version 2.0 and earlier: the SMTP server delay before sending a reject (4xx or 5xx) response, when the client has made fewer than $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_soft_error_limit">smtpd_soft_error_limit</a> errors without delivering mail. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_etrn_restrictions">smtpd_etrn_restrictions</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional SMTP server access restrictions in the context of a client ETRN request. </p> <p> The Postfix ETRN implementation accepts only destinations that are eligible for the Postfix "fast flush" service. See the <a href="ETRN_README.html">ETRN_README</a> file for details. </p> <p> Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction that matches wins. </p> <p> The following restrictions are specific to the domain name information received with the ETRN command. </p> <dl> <dt><b><a name="check_etrn_access">check_etrn_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified access database for the ETRN domain name or its parent domains. See the <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> manual page for details. </dd> </dl> <p> Other restrictions that are valid in this context: </p> <ul> <li><a href="#generic">Generic</a> restrictions that can be used in any SMTP command context, described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>. <li>SMTP command specific restrictions described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a>. </ul> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_etrn_restrictions">smtpd_etrn_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a>, reject </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_expansion_filter">smtpd_expansion_filter</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> What characters are allowed in $name expansions of RBL reply templates. Characters not in the allowed set are replaced by "_". Use C like escapes to specify special characters such as whitespace. </p> <p> This parameter is not subjected to $parameter expansion. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_forbidden_commands">smtpd_forbidden_commands</a> (default: CONNECT, GET, POST)</b></DT><DD> <p> List of commands that causes the Postfix SMTP server to immediately terminate the session with a 221 code. This can be used to disconnect clients that obviously attempt to abuse the system. In addition to the commands listed in this parameter, commands that follow the "Label:" format of message headers will also cause a disconnect. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_hard_error_limit">smtpd_hard_error_limit</a> (default: 20)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of errors a remote SMTP client is allowed to make without delivering mail. The Postfix SMTP server disconnects when the limit is exceeded. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_helo_required">smtpd_helo_required</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Require that a remote SMTP client introduces itself at the beginning of an SMTP session with the HELO or EHLO command. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_required">smtpd_helo_required</a> = yes </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of the SMTP HELO command. </p> <p> The default is to permit everything. </p> <p> Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction that matches wins. </p> <p> The following restrictions are specific to the hostname information received with the HELO or EHLO command. </p> <dl> <dt><b><a name="check_helo_access">check_helo_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the HELO or EHLO hostname or parent domains, and execute the corresponding action. </dd> <dt><b><a name="check_helo_mx_access">check_helo_mx_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the MX hosts for the HELO or EHLO hostname, and execute the corresponding action. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="check_helo_ns_access">check_helo_ns_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the DNS servers for the HELO or EHLO hostname, and execute the corresponding action. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_invalid_helo_hostname">reject_invalid_helo_hostname</a></b> (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_invalid_hostname)</dt> <dd>Reject the request when the HELO or EHLO hostname syntax is invalid. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#invalid_hostname_reject_code">invalid_hostname_reject_code</a> specifies the response code to rejected requests (default: 501).</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname">reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname</a></b> (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_non_fqdn_hostname)</dt> <dd>Reject the request when the HELO or EHLO hostname is not in fully-qualified domain form, as required by the RFC. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#non_fqdn_reject_code">non_fqdn_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code to rejected requests (default: 504).</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unknown_helo_hostname">reject_unknown_helo_hostname</a></b> (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_unknown_hostname)</dt> <dd>Reject the request when the HELO or EHLO hostname has no DNS A or MX record. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#unknown_hostname_reject_code">unknown_hostname_reject_code</a> specifies the response code to rejected requests (default: 450). </dd> </dl> <p> Other restrictions that are valid in this context: </p> <ul> <li> <a href="#generic">Generic</a> restrictions that can be used in any SMTP command context, described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>. <li> Client hostname or network address specific restrictions described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>. <li> SMTP command specific restrictions described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a>. When sender or recipient restrictions are listed under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a>, they have effect only with "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_delay_reject">smtpd_delay_reject</a> = yes", so that $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a> is evaluated at the time of the RCPT TO command. </ul> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_invalid_helo_hostname">reject_invalid_helo_hostname</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_helo_hostname">reject_unknown_helo_hostname</a> </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_history_flush_threshold">smtpd_history_flush_threshold</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of lines in the Postfix SMTP server command history before it is flushed upon receipt of EHLO, RSET, or end of DATA. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_junk_command_limit">smtpd_junk_command_limit</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> The number of junk commands (NOOP, VRFY, ETRN or RSET) that a remote SMTP client can send before the Postfix SMTP server starts to increment the error counter with each junk command. The junk command count is reset after mail is delivered. See also the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_error_sleep_time">smtpd_error_sleep_time</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_soft_error_limit">smtpd_soft_error_limit</a> configuration parameters. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_milters">smtpd_milters</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> A list of Milter (mail filter) applications for new mail that arrives via the Postfix <a href="smtpd.8.html">smtpd(8)</a> server. See the <a href="MILTER_README.html">MILTER_README</a> document for details. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_noop_commands">smtpd_noop_commands</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> List of commands that the Postfix SMTP server replies to with "250 Ok", without doing any syntax checks and without changing state. This list overrides any commands built into the Postfix SMTP server. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_null_access_lookup_key">smtpd_null_access_lookup_key</a> (default: <>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The lookup key to be used in SMTP <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> tables instead of the null sender address. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_peername_lookup">smtpd_peername_lookup</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Attempt to look up the remote SMTP client hostname, and verify that the name matches the client IP address. A client name is set to "unknown" when it cannot be looked up or verified, or when name lookup is disabled. Turning off name lookup reduces delays due to DNS lookup and increases the maximal inbound delivery rate. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_policy_service_max_idle">smtpd_policy_service_max_idle</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which an idle SMTPD policy service connection is closed. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_policy_service_max_ttl">smtpd_policy_service_max_ttl</a> (default: 1000s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which an active SMTPD policy service connection is closed. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_policy_service_timeout">smtpd_policy_service_timeout</a> (default: 100s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for connecting to, writing to or receiving from a delegated SMTPD policy server. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_proxy_ehlo">smtpd_proxy_ehlo</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> How the Postfix SMTP server announces itself to the proxy filter. By default, the Postfix hostname is used. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_proxy_filter">smtpd_proxy_filter</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The hostname and TCP port of the mail filtering proxy server. The proxy receives all mail from the Postfix SMTP server, and is supposed to give the result to another Postfix SMTP server process. </p> <p> Specify "host:port" or "inet:host:port" for a TCP endpoint, or "unix:pathname" for a UNIX-domain endpoint. The host can be specified as an IP address or as a symbolic name; no MX lookups are done. When no "host" or "host:" are specified, the local machine is assumed. Pathname interpretation is relative to the Postfix queue directory. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> <p> The "inet:" and "unix:" prefixes are available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_proxy_timeout">smtpd_proxy_timeout</a> (default: 100s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for connecting to a proxy filter and for sending or receiving information. When a connection fails the client gets a generic error message while more detailed information is logged to the maillog file. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_recipient_limit">smtpd_recipient_limit</a> (default: 1000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipients that the Postfix SMTP server accepts per message delivery request. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_recipient_overshoot_limit">smtpd_recipient_overshoot_limit</a> (default: 1000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The number of recipients that a remote SMTP client can send in excess of the limit specified with $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_limit">smtpd_recipient_limit</a>, before the Postfix SMTP server increments the per-session error count for each excess recipient. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a> (default: <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_destination">reject_unauth_destination</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The access restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of the RCPT TO command. </p> <p> By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts: </p> <ul> <li> Mail from clients whose IP address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a>, or: <li> Mail to remote destinations that match $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a>, except for addresses that contain sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain), or: <li> Mail to local destinations that match $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a>, or $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a>. </ul> <p> IMPORTANT: If you change this parameter setting, you must specify at least one of the following restrictions. Otherwise Postfix will refuse to receive mail: </p> <pre> reject, defer, <a href="postconf.5.html#defer_if_permit">defer_if_permit</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_destination">reject_unauth_destination</a> </pre> <p> Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction that matches wins. </p> <p> The following restrictions are specific to the recipient address that is received with the RCPT TO command. </p> <dl> <dt><b><a name="check_recipient_access">check_recipient_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the resolved RCPT TO address, domain, parent domains, or localpart@, and execute the corresponding action. </dd> <dt><b><a name="check_recipient_mx_access">check_recipient_mx_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the MX hosts for the RCPT TO address, and execute the corresponding action. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="check_recipient_ns_access">check_recipient_ns_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the DNS servers for the RCPT TO address, and execute the corresponding action. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="permit_auth_destination">permit_auth_destination</a></b></dt> <dd>Permit the request when one of the following is true: <ul> <li> Postfix is mail forwarder: the resolved RCPT TO address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a> or a subdomain thereof, and the address contains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain), <li> Postfix is the final destination: the resolved RCPT TO address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a>, or $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a>, and the address contains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain). </ul></dd> <dt><b><a name="permit_mx_backup">permit_mx_backup</a></b></dt> <dd>Permit the request when the local mail system is backup MX for the RCPT TO address, or when the address is an authorized destination (see <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_auth_destination">permit_auth_destination</a> for definition). <ul> <li> Safety: <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mx_backup">permit_mx_backup</a> does not accept addresses that have sender-specified routing information (example: user@elsewhere@domain). <li> Safety: <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mx_backup">permit_mx_backup</a> can be vulnerable to mis-use when access is not restricted with <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mx_backup_networks">permit_mx_backup_networks</a>. <li> Safety: as of Postfix version 2.3, <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mx_backup">permit_mx_backup</a> no longer accepts the address when the local mail system is primary MX for the recipient domain. Exception: <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mx_backup">permit_mx_backup</a> accepts the address when it specifies an authorized destination (see <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_auth_destination">permit_auth_destination</a> for definition). <li> Limitation: mail may be rejected in case of a temporary DNS lookup problem with Postfix prior to version 2.0. </ul></dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_non_fqdn_recipient">reject_non_fqdn_recipient</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the RCPT TO address is not in fully-qualified domain form, as required by the RFC. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#non_fqdn_reject_code">non_fqdn_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code to rejected requests (default: 504). </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_rhsbl_recipient">reject_rhsbl_recipient <i>rbl_domain=d.d.d.d</i></a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the RCPT TO domain is listed with the A record "<i>d.d.d.d</i>" under <i>rbl_domain</i> (Postfix version 2.1 and later only). If no "<i>=d.d.d.d</i>" is specified, reject the request when the RCPT TO domain is listed with any A record under <i>rbl_domain</i>. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#maps_rbl_reject_code">maps_rbl_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 554); the <a href="postconf.5.html#default_rbl_reply">default_rbl_reply</a> parameter specifies the default server reply; and the <a href="postconf.5.html#rbl_reply_maps">rbl_reply_maps</a> parameter specifies tables with server replies indexed by <i>rbl_domain</i>. This feature is available in Postfix version 2.0 and later.</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unauth_destination">reject_unauth_destination</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request unless one of the following is true: <ul> <li> Postfix is mail forwarder: the resolved RCPT TO address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a> or a subdomain thereof, and contains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain), <li> Postfix is the final destination: the resolved RCPT TO address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a>, or $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a>, and contains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain). </ul> The <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains_reject_code">relay_domains_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 554). </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unknown_recipient_domain">reject_unknown_recipient_domain</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when Postfix is not final destination for the recipient address, and the RCPT TO address has no DNS A or MX record, or when it has a malformed MX record such as a record with a zero-length MX hostname (Postfix version 2.3 and later). <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#unknown_address_reject_code">unknown_address_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 450). The response is always 450 in case of a temporary DNS error.</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unlisted_recipient">reject_unlisted_recipient</a></b> (with Postfix version 2.0: check_recipient_maps)</dt> <dd> Reject the request when the RCPT TO address is not listed in the list of valid recipients for its domain class. See the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_reject_unlisted_recipient">smtpd_reject_unlisted_recipient</a> parameter description for details. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unverified_recipient">reject_unverified_recipient</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when mail to the RCPT TO address is known to bounce, or when the recipient address destination is not reachable. Address verification information is managed by the <a href="verify.8.html">verify(8)</a> server; see the <a href="ADDRESS_VERIFICATION_README.html">ADDRESS_VERIFICATION_README</a> file for details. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#unverified_recipient_reject_code">unverified_recipient_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response when an address is known to bounce (default: 450, change into 550 when you are confident that it is safe to do so). Postfix replies with 450 when an address probe failed due to a temporary problem. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> </dl> <p> Other restrictions that are valid in this context: </p> <ul> <li><a href="#generic">Generic</a> restrictions that can be used in any SMTP command context, described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>. <li>SMTP command specific restrictions described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a>. </ul> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unauth_destination">reject_unauth_destination</a> </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_reject_unlisted_recipient">smtpd_reject_unlisted_recipient</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Request that the Postfix SMTP server rejects mail for unknown recipient addresses, even when no explicit <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unlisted_recipient">reject_unlisted_recipient</a> access restriction is specified. This prevents the Postfix queue from filling up with undeliverable MAILER-DAEMON messages. </p> <ul> <li> The recipient domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>, but the recipient is not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a>, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> is not null. <li> The recipient domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a> but the recipient is not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a>. <li> The recipient domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a> but the recipient is not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a>, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a> is not null. <li> The recipient domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a> but the recipient is not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a>, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a> is not null. </ul> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_reject_unlisted_sender">smtpd_reject_unlisted_sender</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Request that the Postfix SMTP server rejects mail from unknown sender addresses, even when no explicit <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unlisted_sender">reject_unlisted_sender</a> access restriction is specified. This can slow down an explosion of forged mail from worms or viruses. </p> <ul> <li> The sender domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>, but the sender is not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a>, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> is not null. <li> The sender domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a> but the sender is not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a>. <li> The sender domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a> but the sender is not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a>, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a> is not null. <li> The sender domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a> but the sender is not listed in $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a>, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a> is not null. </ul> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_restriction_classes">smtpd_restriction_classes</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> User-defined aliases for groups of access restrictions. The aliases can be specified in <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a> etc., and on the right-hand side of a Postfix <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> table. </p> <p> One major application is for implementing per-recipient UCE control. See the <a href="RESTRICTION_CLASS_README.html">RESTRICTION_CLASS_README</a> document for other examples. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_application_name">smtpd_sasl_application_name</a> (default: smtpd)</b></DT><DD> <p> The application name used for SASL server initialization. This controls the name of the SASL configuration file. The default value is <b>smtpd</b>, corresponding to a SASL configuration file named <b>smtpd.conf</b>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and 2.2. With Postfix 2.3 it was renamed to <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_path">smtpd_sasl_path</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_auth_enable">smtpd_sasl_auth_enable</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable SASL authentication in the Postfix SMTP server. By default, the Postfix SMTP server does not use authentication. </p> <p> If a remote SMTP client is authenticated, the <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_sasl_authenticated">permit_sasl_authenticated</a> access restriction can be used to permit relay access, like this: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_mynetworks">permit_mynetworks</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_sasl_authenticated">permit_sasl_authenticated</a>, ... </pre> <p> To reject all SMTP connections from unauthenticated clients, specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_delay_reject">smtpd_delay_reject</a> = yes" (which is the default) and use: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_sasl_authenticated">permit_sasl_authenticated</a>, reject </pre> <p> See the <a href="SASL_README.html">SASL_README</a> file for SASL configuration and operation details. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_authenticated_header">smtpd_sasl_authenticated_header</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Report the SASL authenticated user name in the <a href="smtpd.8.html">smtpd(8)</a> Received message header. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks">smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> What SMTP clients Postfix will not offer AUTH support to. </p> <p> Some clients (Netscape 4 at least) have a bug that causes them to require a login and password whenever AUTH is offered, whether it's necessary or not. To work around this, specify, for example, $<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> to prevent Postfix from offering AUTH to local clients. </p> <p> Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host address. You can also "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside <tt>[]</tt> in the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks">smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks</a> value, and in files specified with "/file/name". IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be confused with a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" pattern. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks">smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#mynetworks">mynetworks</a> </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_local_domain">smtpd_sasl_local_domain</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the local SASL authentication realm. </p> <p> By default, the local authentication realm name is the null string. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_local_domain">smtpd_sasl_local_domain</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydomain">mydomain</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_local_domain">smtpd_sasl_local_domain</a> = $<a href="postconf.5.html#myhostname">myhostname</a> </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_path">smtpd_sasl_path</a> (default: smtpd)</b></DT><DD> <p> Implementation-specific information that is passed through to the SASL plug-in implementation that is selected with <b><a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_type">smtpd_sasl_type</a></b>. Typically this specifies the name of a configuration file or rendezvous point. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. In earlier releases it was called smtpd_sasl_application. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_security_options">smtpd_sasl_security_options</a> (default: noanonymous)</b></DT><DD> <p> SASL security options; as of Postfix 2.3 the list of available features depends on the SASL server implementation that is selected with <b><a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_type">smtpd_sasl_type</a></b>. </p> <p> The following security features are defined for the <b>cyrus</b> server SASL implementation: </p> <p> Restrict what authentication mechanisms the Postfix SMTP server will offer to the client. The list of available authentication mechanisms is system dependent. </p> <p> Specify zero or more of the following: </p> <dl> <dt><b>noplaintext</b></dt> <dd>Disallow methods that use plaintext passwords. </dd> <dt><b>noactive</b></dt> <dd>Disallow methods subject to active (non-dictionary) attack. </dd> <dt><b>nodictionary</b></dt> <dd>Disallow methods subject to passive (dictionary) attack. </dd> <dt><b>noanonymous</b></dt> <dd>Disallow methods that allow anonymous authentication. </dd> <dt><b>mutual_auth</b></dt> <dd>Only allow methods that provide mutual authentication (not available with SASL version 1). </dd> </dl> <p> By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts plaintext passwords but not anonymous logins. </p> <p> Warning: it appears that clients try authentication methods in the order as advertised by the server (e.g., PLAIN ANONYMOUS CRAM-MD5) which means that if you disable plaintext passwords, clients will log in anonymously, even when they should be able to use CRAM-MD5. So, if you disable plaintext logins, disable anonymous logins too. Postfix treats anonymous login as no authentication. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_security_options">smtpd_sasl_security_options</a> = noanonymous, noplaintext </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_tls_security_options">smtpd_sasl_tls_security_options</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sasl_security_options">smtpd_sasl_security_options</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SASL authentication security options that the Postfix SMTP server uses for TLS encrypted SMTP sessions. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sasl_type">smtpd_sasl_type</a> (default: cyrus)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SASL plug-in type that the Postfix SMTP server should use for authentication. The available types are listed with the "<b>postconf -a</b>" command. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sender_login_maps">smtpd_sender_login_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup table with the SASL login names that own sender (MAIL FROM) addresses. </p> <p> Specify zero or more "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup tables. With lookups from indexed files such as DB or DBM, or from networked tables such as NIS, LDAP or SQL, the following search operations are done with a sender address of <i>user@domain</i>: </p> <dl> <dt> 1) <i>user@domain</i> </dt> <dd>This table lookup is always done and has the highest precedence. </dd> <dt> 2) <i>user</i> </dt> <dd>This table lookup is done only when the <i>domain</i> part of the sender address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#myorigin">myorigin</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a>. </dd> <dt> 3) <i>@domain</i> </dt> <dd>This table lookup is done last and has the lowest precedence. </dd> </dl> <p> In all cases the result of table lookup must be either "not found" or a list of SASL login names separated by comma and/or whitespace. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of the MAIL FROM command. </p> <p> The default is to permit everything. </p> <p> Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction that matches wins. </p> <p> The following restrictions are specific to the sender address received with the MAIL FROM command. </p> <dl> <dt><b><a name="check_sender_access">check_sender_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the MAIL FROM address, domain, parent domains, or localpart@, and execute the corresponding action. </dd> <dt><b><a name="check_sender_mx_access">check_sender_mx_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the MX hosts for the MAIL FROM address, and execute the corresponding action. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="check_sender_ns_access">check_sender_ns_access</a> <i><a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a></i></b></dt> <dd>Search the specified <a href="access.5.html">access(5)</a> database for the DNS servers for the MAIL FROM address, and execute the corresponding action. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_authenticated_sender_login_mismatch">reject_authenticated_sender_login_mismatch</a></b></dt> <dd>Enforces the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_sender_login_mismatch">reject_sender_login_mismatch</a> restriction for authenticated clients only. This feature is available in Postfix version 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_non_fqdn_sender">reject_non_fqdn_sender</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the MAIL FROM address is not in fully-qualified domain form, as required by the RFC. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#non_fqdn_reject_code">non_fqdn_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code to rejected requests (default: 504). </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_rhsbl_sender">reject_rhsbl_sender <i>rbl_domain=d.d.d.d</i></a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the MAIL FROM domain is listed with the A record "<i>d.d.d.d</i>" under <i>rbl_domain</i> (Postfix version 2.1 and later only). If no "<i>=d.d.d.d</i>" is specified, reject the request when the MAIL FROM domain is listed with any A record under <i>rbl_domain</i>. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#maps_rbl_reject_code">maps_rbl_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 554); the <a href="postconf.5.html#default_rbl_reply">default_rbl_reply</a> parameter specifies the default server reply; and the <a href="postconf.5.html#rbl_reply_maps">rbl_reply_maps</a> parameter specifies tables with server replies indexed by <i>rbl_domain</i>. This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_sender_login_mismatch">reject_sender_login_mismatch</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_login_maps">smtpd_sender_login_maps</a> specifies an owner for the MAIL FROM address, but the client is not (SASL) logged in as that MAIL FROM address owner; or when the client is (SASL) logged in, but the client login name doesn't own the MAIL FROM address according to $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_login_maps">smtpd_sender_login_maps</a>.</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unauthenticated_sender_login_mismatch">reject_unauthenticated_sender_login_mismatch</a></b></dt> <dd>Enforces the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_sender_login_mismatch">reject_sender_login_mismatch</a> restriction for unauthenticated clients only. This feature is available in Postfix version 2.1 and later. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unknown_sender_domain">reject_unknown_sender_domain</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when Postfix is not final destination for the sender address, and the MAIL FROM address has no DNS A or MX record, or when it has a malformed MX record such as a record with a zero-length MX hostname (Postfix version 2.3 and later). <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#unknown_address_reject_code">unknown_address_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 450). The response is always 450 in case of a temporary DNS error. </dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unlisted_sender">reject_unlisted_sender</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when the MAIL FROM address is not listed in the list of valid recipients for its domain class. See the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_reject_unlisted_sender">smtpd_reject_unlisted_sender</a> parameter description for details. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.</dd> <dt><b><a name="reject_unverified_sender">reject_unverified_sender</a></b></dt> <dd>Reject the request when mail to the MAIL FROM address is known to bounce, or when the sender address destination is not reachable. Address verification information is managed by the <a href="verify.8.html">verify(8)</a> server; see the <a href="ADDRESS_VERIFICATION_README.html">ADDRESS_VERIFICATION_README</a> file for details. <br> The <a href="postconf.5.html#unverified_sender_reject_code">unverified_sender_reject_code</a> parameter specifies the response when an address is known to bounce (default: 450, change into 550 when you are confident that it is safe to do so). Postfix replies with 450 when an address probe failed due to a temporary problem. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </dd> </dl> <p> Other restrictions that are valid in this context: </p> <ul> <li> <a href="#generic">Generic</a> restrictions that can be used in any SMTP command context, described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a>. <li> SMTP command specific restrictions described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_client_restrictions">smtpd_client_restrictions</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_helo_restrictions">smtpd_helo_restrictions</a>. <li> SMTP command specific restrictions described under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_recipient_restrictions">smtpd_recipient_restrictions</a>. When recipient restrictions are listed under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a>, they have effect only with "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_delay_reject">smtpd_delay_reject</a> = yes", so that $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a> is evaluated at the time of the RCPT TO command. </ul> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_sender_domain">reject_unknown_sender_domain</a> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_sender_restrictions">smtpd_sender_restrictions</a> = <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_sender_domain">reject_unknown_sender_domain</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#check_sender_access">check_sender_access</a> hash:/etc/postfix/access </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_soft_error_limit">smtpd_soft_error_limit</a> (default: 10)</b></DT><DD> <p> The number of errors a remote SMTP client is allowed to make without delivering mail before the Postfix SMTP server slows down all its responses. </p> <ul> <li><p>With Postfix version 2.1 and later, the Postfix SMTP server delays all responses by $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_error_sleep_time">smtpd_error_sleep_time</a> seconds. </p> <li><p>With Postfix versions 2.0 and earlier, the Postfix SMTP server delays all responses by (number of errors) seconds. </p> </ul> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_starttls_timeout">smtpd_starttls_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for Postfix SMTP server write and read operations during TLS startup and shutdown handshake procedures. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_timeout">smtpd_timeout</a> (default: 300s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for sending a Postfix SMTP server response and for receiving a remote SMTP client request. </p> <p> Note: if you set SMTP time limits to very large values you may have to update the global <a href="postconf.5.html#ipc_timeout">ipc_timeout</a> parameter. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_CAfile">smtpd_tls_CAfile</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The file with the certificate of the certification authority (CA) that issued the Postfix SMTP server certificate. This is needed only when the CA certificate is not already present in the server certificate file. This file may also contain the CA certificates of other trusted CAs. You must use this file for the list of trusted CAs if you want to use chroot-mode. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_CAfile">smtpd_tls_CAfile</a> = /etc/postfix/CAcert.pem </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_CApath">smtpd_tls_CApath</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Directory with PEM format certificate authority certificates that the Postfix SMTP server offers to remote SMTP clients for the purpose of client certificate verification. Do not forget to create the necessary "hash" links with, for example, "$OPENSSL_HOME/bin/c_rehash /etc/postfix/certs". </p> <p> To use this option in chroot mode, this directory (or a copy) must be inside the chroot jail. Please note that in this case the CA certificates are not offered to the client, so that e.g. Netscape clients might not offer certificates issued by them. Use of this feature is therefore not recommended. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_CApath">smtpd_tls_CApath</a> = /etc/postfix/certs </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids">smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Force the Postfix SMTP server to issue a TLS session id, even when TLS session caching is turned off (<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_session_cache_database">smtpd_tls_session_cache_database</a> is empty). This behavior is compatible with Postfix < 2.3. </p> <p> With Postfix 2.3 and later the Postfix SMTP server can disable session id generation when TLS session caching is turned off. This keeps clients from caching sessions that almost certainly cannot be re-used. </p> <p> By default, the Postfix SMTP server always generates TLS session ids. This works around a known defect in mail client applications such as MS Outlook, and may also prevent interoperability issues with other MTAs. </p> <p> Example: </p> <blockquote> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids">smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids</a> = no </pre> </blockquote> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_ask_ccert">smtpd_tls_ask_ccert</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Ask a remote SMTP client for a client certificate. This information is needed for certificate based mail relaying with, for example, the <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_tls_clientcerts">permit_tls_clientcerts</a> feature. </p> <p> Some clients such as Netscape will either complain if no certificate is available (for the list of CAs in $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_CAfile">smtpd_tls_CAfile</a>) or will offer multiple client certificates to choose from. This may be annoying, so this option is "off" by default. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_auth_only">smtpd_tls_auth_only</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> When TLS encryption is optional in the Postfix SMTP server, do not announce or accept SASL authentication over unencrypted connections. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_ccert_verifydepth">smtpd_tls_ccert_verifydepth</a> (default: 5)</b></DT><DD> <p> The verification depth for remote SMTP client certificates. A depth of 1 is sufficient if the issuing CA is listed in a local CA file. The default value should also suffice for longer chains (the root CA issues special CA which then issues the actual certificate...). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_cert_file">smtpd_tls_cert_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with the Postfix SMTP server RSA certificate in PEM format. This file may also contain the Postfix SMTP server private RSA key. </p> <p> Public Internet MX hosts without certificates signed by a "reputable" CA must generate, and be prepared to present to most clients, a self-signed or private-CA signed certificate. The client will not be able to authenticate the server, but unless it is running Postfix 2.3 or similar software, it will still insist on a server certificate. </p> <p> For servers that are <b>not</b> public Internet MX hosts, Postfix 2.3 supports configurations with no certificates. This entails the use of just the anonymous TLS ciphers, which are not supported by typical SMTP clients. Since such clients will not, as a rule, fall back to plain text after a TLS handshake failure, the server will be unable to receive email from TLS enabled clients. To avoid accidental configurations with no certificates, Postfix 2.3 enables certificate-less operation only when the administrator explicitly sets "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_cert_file">smtpd_tls_cert_file</a> = none". This ensures that new Postfix configurations will not accidentally run with no certificates. </p> <p> Both RSA and DSA certificates are supported. When both types are present, the cipher used determines which certificate will be presented to the client. For Netscape and OpenSSL clients without special cipher choices the RSA certificate is preferred. </p> <p> In order to verify a certificate, the CA certificate (in case of a certificate chain, all CA certificates) must be available. You should add these certificates to the server certificate, the server certificate first, then the issuing CA(s). </p> <p> Example: the certificate for "server.dom.ain" was issued by "intermediate CA" which itself has a certificate of "root CA". Create the server.pem file with "cat server_cert.pem intermediate_CA.pem root_CA.pem > server.pem". </p> <p> If you also want to verify client certificates issued by these CAs, you can add the CA certificates to the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_CAfile">smtpd_tls_CAfile</a>, in which case it is not necessary to have them in the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_cert_file">smtpd_tls_cert_file</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_dcert_file">smtpd_tls_dcert_file</a>. </p> <p> A certificate supplied here must be usable as an SSL server certificate and hence pass the "openssl verify -purpose sslserver ..." test. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_cert_file">smtpd_tls_cert_file</a> = /etc/postfix/server.pem </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_cipherlist">smtpd_tls_cipherlist</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Obsolete Postfix < 2.3 control for the Postfix SMTP server TLS cipher list. It is easy to create inter-operability problems by choosing a non-default cipher list. Do not use a non-default TLS cipherlist for MX hosts on the public Internet. Clients that begin the TLS handshake, but are unable to agree on a common cipher, may not be able to send any email to the SMTP server. Using a restricted cipher list may be more appropriate for a dedicated MSA or an internal mailhub, where one can exert some control over the TLS software and settings of the connecting clients. </p> <p> <b>Note:</b> do not use "" quotes around the parameter value. </p> <p>This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2. It is not used with Postfix 2.3 and later; use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_dcert_file">smtpd_tls_dcert_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with the Postfix SMTP server DSA certificate in PEM format. This file may also contain the Postfix SMTP server private key. <p> <p> See the discussion under <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_cert_file">smtpd_tls_cert_file</a> for more details. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_dcert_file">smtpd_tls_dcert_file</a> = /etc/postfix/server-dsa.pem </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file">smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with DH parameters that the Postfix SMTP server should use with EDH ciphers. </p> <p> Instead of using the exact same parameter sets as distributed with other TLS packages, it is more secure to generate your own set of parameters with something like the following command: </p> <pre> openssl gendh -out /etc/postfix/dh_1024.pem -2 -rand /var/run/egd-pool 1024 </pre> <p> Your actual source for entropy may differ. Some systems have /dev/random; on other system you may consider using the "Entropy Gathering Daemon EGD", available at <a href="http://egd.sourceforge.net/">http://egd.sourceforge.net/</a> </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file">smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file</a> = /etc/postfix/dh_1024.pem </pre> <p>This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.</p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file">smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with DH parameters that the Postfix SMTP server should use with EDH ciphers. </p> <p> See also the discussion under the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file">smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file</a> configuration parameter. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file">smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file</a> = /etc/postfix/dh_512.pem </pre> <p>This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.</p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_dkey_file">smtpd_tls_dkey_file</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_dcert_file">smtpd_tls_dcert_file</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with the Postfix SMTP server DSA private key in PEM format. This file may be combined with the Postfix SMTP server DSA certificate file specified with $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_dcert_file">smtpd_tls_dcert_file</a>. </p> <p> The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted, but file permissions should grant read/write access only to the system superuser account ("root"). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> List of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the SMTP server cipher list at all TLS security levels. Excluding valid ciphers can create interoperability problems. DO NOT exclude ciphers unless it is essential to do so. This is not an OpenSSL cipherlist; it is a simple list separated by whitespace and/or commas. The elements are a single cipher, or one or more "+" separated cipher properties, in which case only ciphers matching <b>all</b> the properties are excluded. </p> <p> Examples (some of these will cause problems): </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = MD5, DES <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = DES+MD5 <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = AES256-SHA, DES-CBC3-MD5 <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = kEDH+aRSA </pre> <p> The first setting disables anonymous ciphers. The next setting disables ciphers that use the MD5 digest algorithm or the (single) DES encryption algorithm. The next setting disables ciphers that use MD5 and DES together. The next setting disables the two ciphers "AES256-SHA" and "DES-CBC3-MD5". The last setting disables ciphers that use "EDH" key exchange with RSA authentication. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_key_file">smtpd_tls_key_file</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_cert_file">smtpd_tls_cert_file</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> File with the Postfix SMTP server RSA private key in PEM format. This file may be combined with the Postfix SMTP server certificate file specified with $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_cert_file">smtpd_tls_cert_file</a>. </p> <p> The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted, but file permissions should grant read/write access only to the system superuser account ("root"). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_loglevel">smtpd_tls_loglevel</a> (default: 0)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable additional Postfix SMTP server logging of TLS activity. Each logging level also includes the information that is logged at a lower logging level. </p> <dl compact> <dt> </dt> <dd> 0 Disable logging of TLS activity. </dd> <dt> </dt> <dd> 1 Log TLS handshake and certificate information. </dd> <dt> </dt> <dd> 2 Log levels during TLS negotiation. </dd> <dt> </dt> <dd> 3 Log hexadecimal and ASCII dump of TLS negotiation process. </dd> <dt> </dt> <dd> 4 Also log hexadecimal and ASCII dump of complete transmission after STARTTLS. </dd> </dl> <p> Use "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_loglevel">smtpd_tls_loglevel</a> = 3" only in case of problems. Use of loglevel 4 is strongly discouraged. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> (default: medium)</b></DT><DD> <p> The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix SMTP server will use with mandatory TLS encryption. Cipher types listed in <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> are excluded from the base definition of the selected cipher grade. With opportunistic TLS encryption, the "export" grade is used unconditionally with exclusions specified only via <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a>. </p> <p> The following cipher grades are supported: </p> <dl> <dt><b>export</b></dt> <dd> Enable the mainstream "EXPORT" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers. This is the most appropriate setting for public MX hosts, and is always used with opportunistic TLS encryption. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_export_cipherlist">tls_export_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_export_cipherlist">tls_export_cipherlist</a> includes anonymous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the server is configured to ask for client certificates. If you must always exclude anonymous ciphers, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". To exclude anonymous ciphers only when TLS is enforced, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". </dd> <dt><b>low</b></dt> <dd> Enable the mainstream "LOW" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_low_cipherlist">tls_low_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_low_cipherlist">tls_low_cipherlist</a> includes anonymous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the server is configured to ask for client certificates. If you must always exclude anonymous ciphers, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". To exclude anonymous ciphers only when TLS is enforced, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". </dd> <dt><b>medium</b></dt> <dd> Enable the mainstream "MEDIUM" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers. These are essentially the 128-bit or stronger ciphers. This is the default minimum strength for mandatory TLS encryption. MSAs that enforce TLS and have clients that do not support any "MEDIUM" or "HIGH" grade ciphers, may need to configure a weaker ("low" or "export") minimum cipher grade. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_medium_cipherlist">tls_medium_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_medium_cipherlist">tls_medium_cipherlist</a> includes anonymous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the server is configured to ask for client certificates. If you must always exclude anonymous ciphers, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". To exclude anonymous ciphers only when TLS is enforced, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". </dd> <dt><b>high</b></dt> <dd> Enable only the mainstream "HIGH" grade OpenSSL ciphers. The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_high_cipherlist">tls_high_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_high_cipherlist">tls_high_cipherlist</a> includes anonymous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the server is configured to ask for client certificates. If you must always exclude anonymous ciphers, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". To exclude anonymous ciphers only when TLS is enforced, set "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> = aNULL". </dd> <dt><b>null</b></dt> <dd> Enable only the "NULL" OpenSSL ciphers, these provide authentication without encryption. This setting is only appropriate in the rare case that all clients are prepared to use NULL ciphers (not normally enabled in TLS clients). The underlying cipherlist is specified via the <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_null_cipherlist">tls_null_cipherlist</a> configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change. The default value of <a href="postconf.5.html#tls_null_cipherlist">tls_null_cipherlist</a> excludes anonymous ciphers (OpenSSL 0.9.8 has NULL ciphers that offer data integrity without encryption or authentication). </dd> </dl> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Additional list of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the SMTP server cipher list at mandatory TLS security levels. This list works in addition to the exclusions listed with <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers">smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers</a> (see there for syntax details). </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> (default: SSLv3, TLSv1)</b></DT><DD> <p> The TLS protocols accepted by the Postfix SMTP server with mandatory TLS encryption. With opportunistic TLS encryption, all protocols are always accepted. If the list is empty, the server supports all available TLS protocol versions. A non-empty value is a list of protocol names separated by whitespace, commas or colons. The supported protocol names are "SSLv2", "SSLv3" and "TLSv1", and are not case sensitive. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols">smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols</a> = SSLv3, TLSv1 </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_received_header">smtpd_tls_received_header</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Request that the Postfix SMTP server produces Received: message headers that include information about the protocol and cipher used, as well as the client CommonName and client certificate issuer CommonName. This is disabled by default, as the information may be modified in transit through other mail servers. Only information that was recorded by the final destination can be trusted. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_req_ccert">smtpd_tls_req_ccert</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> With mandatory TLS encryption, require a remote SMTP client certificate in order to allow TLS connections to proceed. This option implies "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_ask_ccert">smtpd_tls_ask_ccert</a> = yes". </p> <p> When TLS encryption is optional, this setting is ignored with a warning written to the mail log. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_security_level">smtpd_tls_security_level</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP TLS security level for the Postfix SMTP server; when a non-empty value is specified, this overrides the obsolete parameters <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_use_tls">smtpd_use_tls</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_enforce_tls">smtpd_enforce_tls</a>. This parameter is ignored with "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_wrappermode">smtpd_tls_wrappermode</a> = yes". </p> <p> Specify one of the following security levels: </p> <dl> <dt><b>none</b></dt> <dd> TLS will not be used. </dd> <dt><b>may</b></dt> <dd> Opportunistic TLS: announce STARTTLS support to SMTP clients, but do not require that clients use TLS encryption. </dd> <dt><b>encrypt</b></dt> <dd>Mandatory TLS encryption: announce STARTTLS support to SMTP clients, and require that clients use TLS encryption. According to <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc2487.html">RFC 2487</a> this MUST NOT be applied in case of a publicly-referenced SMTP server. Instead, this option should be used only on dedicated servers. </dd> </dl> <p> Note 1: the "verify" and "secure" levels are not supported. The Postfix SMTP server logs a warning and uses "encrypt" instead. To verify SMTP client certificates, see <a href="TLS_README.html">TLS_README</a> for a discussion of the <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_ask_ccert">smtpd_tls_ask_ccert</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_req_ccert">smtpd_tls_req_ccert</a>, and <a href="postconf.5.html#permit_tls_clientcerts">permit_tls_clientcerts</a> features. </p> <p> Note 2: The parameter setting "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_security_level">smtpd_tls_security_level</a> = encrypt" implies "<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_auth_only">smtpd_tls_auth_only</a> = yes".</p> <p> Note 3: when invoked via "sendmail -bs", Postfix will never offer STARTTLS due to insufficient privileges to access the server private key. This is intended behavior.</p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_session_cache_database">smtpd_tls_session_cache_database</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Name of the file containing the optional Postfix SMTP server TLS session cache. Specify a database type that supports enumeration, such as <b>btree</b> or <b>sdbm</b>; there is no need to support concurrent access. The file is created if it does not exist. The <a href="smtpd.8.html">smtpd(8)</a> daemon does not use this parameter directly, rather the cache is implemented indirectly in the <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> daemon. This means that per-smtpd-instance <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> overrides of this parameter are not effective. Note, that each of the cache databases supported by <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> daemon: $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_session_cache_database">smtpd_tls_session_cache_database</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_session_cache_database">smtp_tls_session_cache_database</a> (and with Postfix 2.3 and later $lmtp_session_cache_database), needs to be stored separately, it is not at this time possible to store multiple caches in a single database. </p> <p> Note: <b>dbm</b> databases are not suitable. TLS session objects are too large. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_session_cache_database">smtpd_tls_session_cache_database</a> = btree:/var/spool/postfix/smtpd_scache </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout">smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout</a> (default: 3600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The expiration time of Postfix SMTP server TLS session cache information. A cache cleanup is performed periodically every $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout">smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout</a> seconds. As with $<a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_session_cache_database">smtpd_tls_session_cache_database</a>, this parameter is implemented in the <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> daemon and therefore per-smtpd-instance <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> overrides are not possible. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_tls_wrappermode">smtpd_tls_wrappermode</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Run the Postfix SMTP server in the non-standard "wrapper" mode, instead of using the STARTTLS command. </p> <p> If you want to support this service, enable a special port in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>, and specify "-o <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_wrappermode">smtpd_tls_wrappermode</a>=yes" on the SMTP server's command line. Port 465 (smtps) was once chosen for this purpose. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="smtpd_use_tls">smtpd_use_tls</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Opportunistic TLS: announce STARTTLS support to SMTP clients, but do not require that clients use TLS encryption. </p> <p> Note: when invoked via "<b>sendmail -bs</b>", Postfix will never offer STARTTLS due to insufficient privileges to access the server private key. This is intended behavior. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3 and later use <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_security_level">smtpd_tls_security_level</a> instead. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="soft_bounce">soft_bounce</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Safety net to keep mail queued that would otherwise be returned to the sender. This parameter disables locally-generated bounces, and prevents the Postfix SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently, by changing 5xx reply codes into 4xx. However, <a href="postconf.5.html#soft_bounce">soft_bounce</a> is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#soft_bounce">soft_bounce</a> = yes </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="stale_lock_time">stale_lock_time</a> (default: 500s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time after which a stale exclusive mailbox lockfile is removed. This is used for delivery to file or mailbox. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="strict_7bit_headers">strict_7bit_headers</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Reject mail with 8-bit text in message headers. This blocks mail from poorly written applications. </p> <p> This feature should not be enabled on a general purpose mail server, because it is likely to reject legitimate email. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="strict_8bitmime">strict_8bitmime</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable both <a href="postconf.5.html#strict_7bit_headers">strict_7bit_headers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#strict_8bitmime_body">strict_8bitmime_body</a>. </p> <p> This feature should not be enabled on a general purpose mail server, because it is likely to reject legitimate email. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="strict_8bitmime_body">strict_8bitmime_body</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Reject 8-bit message body text without 8-bit MIME content encoding information. This blocks mail from poorly written applications. </p> <p> Unfortunately, this also rejects majordomo approval requests when the included request contains valid 8-bit MIME mail, and it rejects bounces from mailers that do not MIME encapsulate 8-bit content (for example, bounces from qmail or from old versions of Postfix). </p> <p> This feature should not be enabled on a general purpose mail server, because it is likely to reject legitimate email. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="strict_mime_encoding_domain">strict_mime_encoding_domain</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Reject mail with invalid Content-Transfer-Encoding: information for the message/* or multipart/* MIME content types. This blocks mail from poorly written software. </p> <p> This feature should not be enabled on a general purpose mail server, because it will reject mail after a single violation. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="strict_rfc821_envelopes">strict_rfc821_envelopes</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Require that addresses received in SMTP MAIL FROM and RCPT TO commands are enclosed with <>, and that those addresses do not contain <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc822.html">RFC 822</a> style comments or phrases. This stops mail from poorly written software. </p> <p> By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc822.html">RFC 822</a> syntax in MAIL FROM and RCPT TO addresses. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="sun_mailtool_compatibility">sun_mailtool_compatibility</a> (default: no)</b></DT><DD> <p> Obsolete SUN mailtool compatibility feature. Instead, use "<a href="postconf.5.html#mailbox_delivery_lock">mailbox_delivery_lock</a> = dotlock". </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="swap_bangpath">swap_bangpath</a> (default: yes)</b></DT><DD> <p> Enable the rewriting of "site!user" into "user@site". This is necessary if your machine is connected to UUCP networks. It is enabled by default. </p> <p> Note: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting happens only when one of the following conditions is true: </p> <ul> <li> The message is received with the Postfix <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command, <li> The message is received from a network client that matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a>, <li> The message is received from the network, and the <a href="postconf.5.html#remote_header_rewrite_domain">remote_header_rewrite_domain</a> parameter specifies a non-empty value. </ul> <p> To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "<a href="postconf.5.html#local_header_rewrite_clients">local_header_rewrite_clients</a> = static:all". </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#swap_bangpath">swap_bangpath</a> = no </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="syslog_facility">syslog_facility</a> (default: mail)</b></DT><DD> <p> The syslog facility of Postfix logging. Specify a facility as defined in syslog.conf(5). The default facility is "mail". </p> <p> Warning: a non-default <a href="postconf.5.html#syslog_facility">syslog_facility</a> setting takes effect only after a Postfix process has completed initialization. Errors during process initialization will be logged with the default facility. Examples are errors while parsing the command line arguments, and errors while accessing the Postfix <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> configuration file. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="syslog_name">syslog_name</a> (default: postfix)</b></DT><DD> <p> The mail system name that is prepended to the process name in syslog records, so that "smtpd" becomes, for example, "postfix/smtpd". </p> <p> Warning: a non-default <a href="postconf.5.html#syslog_name">syslog_name</a> setting takes effect only after a Postfix process has completed initialization. Errors during process initialization will be logged with the default name. Examples are errors while parsing the command line arguments, and errors while accessing the Postfix <a href="postconf.5.html">main.cf</a> configuration file. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_daemon_random_bytes">tls_daemon_random_bytes</a> (default: 32)</b></DT><DD> <p> The number of pseudo-random bytes that an <a href="smtp.8.html">smtp(8)</a> or <a href="smtpd.8.html">smtpd(8)</a> process requests from the <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> server in order to seed its internal pseudo random number generator (PRNG). The default of 32 bytes (equivalent to 256 bits) is sufficient to generate a 128bit (or 168bit) session key. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_export_cipherlist">tls_export_cipherlist</a> (default: ALL:+RC4:@STRENGTH)</b></DT><DD> <p> The OpenSSL cipherlist for "EXPORT" or higher grade ciphers. This defines the meaning of the "export" setting in <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>. This is the cipherlist for the opportunistic ("may") TLS client security level and is the default cipherlist for the SMTP server. You are strongly encouraged to not change this setting. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_high_cipherlist">tls_high_cipherlist</a> (default: ALL:!EXPORT:!LOW:!MEDIUM:+RC4:@STRENGTH)</b></DT><DD> <p> The OpenSSL cipherlist for "HIGH" grade ciphers. This defines the meaning of the "high" setting in <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>. You are strongly encouraged to not change this setting. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_low_cipherlist">tls_low_cipherlist</a> (default: ALL:!EXPORT:+RC4:@STRENGTH)</b></DT><DD> <p> The OpenSSL cipherlist for "LOW" or higher grade ciphers. This defines the meaning of the "low" setting in <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>. You are strongly encouraged to not change this setting. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_medium_cipherlist">tls_medium_cipherlist</a> (default: ALL:!EXPORT:!LOW:+RC4:@STRENGTH)</b></DT><DD> <p> The OpenSSL cipherlist for "MEDIUM" or higher grade ciphers. This defines the meaning of the "medium" setting in <a href="postconf.5.html#smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>. This is the default cipherlist for mandatory TLS encryption in the TLS client (with anonymous ciphers disabled when verifying server certificates). You are strongly encouraged to not change this setting. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_null_cipherlist">tls_null_cipherlist</a> (default: eNULL:!aNULL)</b></DT><DD> <p> The OpenSSL cipherlist for "NULL" grade ciphers that provide authentication without encryption. This defines the meaning of the "null" setting in smtpd_mandatory_tls_ciphers, <a href="postconf.5.html#smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers">lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers</a>. You are strongly encouraged to not change this setting. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_random_bytes">tls_random_bytes</a> (default: 32)</b></DT><DD> <p> The number of bytes that <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> reads from $<a href="postconf.5.html#tls_random_source">tls_random_source</a> when (re)seeding the in-memory pseudo random number generator (PRNG) pool. The default of 32 bytes (256 bits) is good enough for 128bit symmetric keys. If using EGD or a device file, a maximum of 255 bytes is read. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_random_exchange_name">tls_random_exchange_name</a> (default: ${<a href="postconf.5.html#config_directory">config_directory</a>}/prng_exch)</b></DT><DD> <p> Name of the pseudo random number generator (PRNG) state file that is maintained by <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a>. The file is created when it does not exist, and its length is fixed at 1024 bytes. </p> <p> Since this file is modified by Postfix, it should probably be kept in the /var file system, instead of under $<a href="postconf.5.html#config_directory">config_directory</a>. The location should not be inside the chroot jail. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_random_prng_update_period">tls_random_prng_update_period</a> (default: 3600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time between attempts by <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> to save the state of the pseudo random number generator (PRNG) to the file specified with $<a href="postconf.5.html#tls_random_exchange_name">tls_random_exchange_name</a>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_random_reseed_period">tls_random_reseed_period</a> (default: 3600s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal time between attempts by <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> to re-seed the in-memory pseudo random number generator (PRNG) pool from external sources. The actual time between re-seeding attempts is calculated using the PRNG, and is between 0 and the time specified. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="tls_random_source">tls_random_source</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> The external entropy source for the in-memory <a href="tlsmgr.8.html">tlsmgr(8)</a> pseudo random number generator (PRNG) pool. Be sure to specify a non-blocking source. If this source is not a regular file, the entropy source type must be prepended: egd:/path/to/egd_socket for a source with EGD compatible socket interface, or dev:/path/to/device for a device file. </p> <p> Note: on OpenBSD systems specify /dev/arandom when /dev/urandom gives timeout errors. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="trace_service_name">trace_service_name</a> (default: trace)</b></DT><DD> <p> The name of the trace service. This service is implemented by the <a href="bounce.8.html">bounce(8)</a> daemon and maintains a record of mail deliveries and produces a mail delivery report when verbose delivery is requested with "<b>sendmail -v</b>". </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="transport_maps">transport_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with mappings from recipient address to (message delivery transport, next-hop destination). See <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> for details. </p> <p> Specify zero or more "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup tables. If you use this feature with local files, run "<b>postmap /etc/postfix/transport</b>" after making a change. </p> <p> For safety reasons, as of Postfix 2.3 this feature does not allow $number substitutions in regular expression maps. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#transport_maps">transport_maps</a> = dbm:/etc/postfix/transport <a href="postconf.5.html#transport_maps">transport_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/transport </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="transport_retry_time">transport_retry_time</a> (default: 60s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time between attempts by the Postfix queue manager to contact a malfunctioning message delivery transport. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="trigger_timeout">trigger_timeout</a> (default: 10s)</b></DT><DD> <p> The time limit for sending a trigger to a Postfix daemon (for example, the <a href="pickup.8.html">pickup(8)</a> or <a href="qmgr.8.html">qmgr(8)</a> daemon). This time limit prevents programs from getting stuck when the mail system is under heavy load. </p> <p> Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s (seconds). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="undisclosed_recipients_header">undisclosed_recipients_header</a> (default: To: undisclosed-recipients:;)</b></DT><DD> <p> Message header that the Postfix <a href="cleanup.8.html">cleanup(8)</a> server inserts when a message contains no To: or Cc: message header. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unknown_address_reject_code">unknown_address_reject_code</a> (default: 450)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a sender or recipient address is rejected by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_sender_domain">reject_unknown_sender_domain</a> or <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_recipient_domain">reject_unknown_recipient_domain</a> restriction. The response is always 450 in case of a temporary DNS error. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unknown_client_reject_code">unknown_client_reject_code</a> (default: 450)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a client without valid address <=> name mapping is rejected by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_client_hostname">reject_unknown_client_hostname</a> restriction. The SMTP server always replies with 450 when the mapping failed due to a temporary error condition. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unknown_hostname_reject_code">unknown_hostname_reject_code</a> (default: 450)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when the hostname specified with the HELO or EHLO command is rejected by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unknown_helo_hostname">reject_unknown_helo_hostname</a> restriction. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unknown_local_recipient_reject_code">unknown_local_recipient_reject_code</a> (default: 550)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a recipient address is local, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> specifies a list of lookup tables that does not match the recipient. A recipient address is local when its domain matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a>, $<a href="postconf.5.html#proxy_interfaces">proxy_interfaces</a> or $<a href="postconf.5.html#inet_interfaces">inet_interfaces</a>. </p> <p> The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to initially use 450 (try again later) so you have time to find out if your <a href="postconf.5.html#local_recipient_maps">local_recipient_maps</a> settings are OK. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#unknown_local_recipient_reject_code">unknown_local_recipient_reject_code</a> = 450 </pre> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unknown_relay_recipient_reject_code">unknown_relay_recipient_reject_code</a> (default: 550)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server reply code when a recipient address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#relay_domains">relay_domains</a>, and <a href="postconf.5.html#relay_recipient_maps">relay_recipient_maps</a> specifies a list of lookup tables that does not match the recipient address. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unknown_virtual_alias_reject_code">unknown_virtual_alias_reject_code</a> (default: 550)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP server reply code when a recipient address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a>, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a> specifies a list of lookup tables that does not match the recipient address. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unknown_virtual_mailbox_reject_code">unknown_virtual_mailbox_reject_code</a> (default: 550)</b></DT><DD> <p> The SMTP server reply code when a recipient address matches $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a>, and $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a> specifies a list of lookup tables that does not match the recipient address. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unverified_recipient_reject_code">unverified_recipient_reject_code</a> (default: 450)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response when a recipient address is rejected by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unverified_recipient">reject_unverified_recipient</a> restriction. </p> <p> Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the address anyway. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="unverified_sender_reject_code">unverified_sender_reject_code</a> (default: 450)</b></DT><DD> <p> The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a recipient address is rejected by the <a href="postconf.5.html#reject_unverified_sender">reject_unverified_sender</a> restriction. </p> <p> Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the address anyway. </p> <p> Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of <a href="http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc821.html">RFC 821</a>. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="verp_delimiter_filter">verp_delimiter_filter</a> (default: -=+)</b></DT><DD> <p> The characters Postfix accepts as VERP delimiter characters on the Postfix <a href="sendmail.1.html">sendmail(1)</a> command line and in SMTP commands. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Postfix is final destination for the specified list of virtual alias domains, that is, domains for which all addresses are aliased to addresses in other local or remote domains. The SMTP server validates recipient addresses with $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a> and rejects non-existent recipients. See also the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html#virtual_alias_class">virtual alias domain</a> class in the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html">ADDRESS_CLASS_README</a> file </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. The default value is backwards compatible with Postfix version 1.1. </p> <p> The default value is $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a> so that you can keep all information about <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html#virtual_alias_class">virtual alias domains</a> in one place. If you have many users, it is better to separate information that changes more frequently (virtual address -> local or remote address mapping) from information that changes less frequently (the list of virtual domain names). </p> <p> Specify a list of host or domain names, "/file/name" or "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "<a href="DATABASE_README.html">type:table</a>" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored). Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a host or domain name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later. </p> <p> See also the <a href="VIRTUAL_README.html">VIRTUAL_README</a> and <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html">ADDRESS_CLASS_README</a> documents for further information. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a> = virtual1.tld virtual2.tld </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_alias_expansion_limit">virtual_alias_expansion_limit</a> (default: 1000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of addresses that virtual alias expansion produces from each original recipient. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_maps">virtual_maps</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables that alias specific mail addresses or domains to other local or remote address. The table format and lookups are documented in <a href="virtual.5.html">virtual(5)</a>. For an overview of Postfix address manipulations see the <a href="ADDRESS_REWRITING_README.html">ADDRESS_REWRITING_README</a> document. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. The default value is backwards compatible with Postfix version 1.1. </p> <p> If you use this feature with indexed files, run "<b>postmap /etc/postfix/virtual</b>" after changing the file. </p> <p> Examples: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a> = dbm:/etc/postfix/virtual <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a> = hash:/etc/postfix/virtual </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_alias_recursion_limit">virtual_alias_recursion_limit</a> (default: 1000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal nesting depth of virtual alias expansion. Currently the recursion limit is applied only to the left branch of the expansion graph, so the depth of the tree can in the worst case reach the sum of the expansion and recursion limits. This may change in the future. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_destination_concurrency_limit">virtual_destination_concurrency_limit</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_destination_concurrency_limit">default_destination_concurrency_limit</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same destination via the virtual message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_destination_recipient_limit">virtual_destination_recipient_limit</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#default_destination_recipient_limit">default_destination_recipient_limit</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal number of recipients per delivery via the virtual message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a> file. </p> <p> Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the meaning of <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_destination_concurrency_limit">virtual_destination_concurrency_limit</a> from concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_gid_maps">virtual_gid_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Lookup tables with the per-recipient group ID for <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> mailbox delivery. </p> <p> In a lookup table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld" to match any user in the specified domain that does not have a specific "user@domain.tld" entry. </p> <p> When a recipient address has an optional address extension (user+foo@domain.tld), the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent looks up the full address first, and when the lookup fails, it looks up the unextended address (user@domain.tld). </p> <p> Note 1: for security reasons, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution of $1 etc. in regular expression lookup tables, because that would open a security hole. </p> <p> Note 2: for security reasons, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent will silently ignore requests to use the <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxymap(8)</a> server. Instead it will open the table directly. Before Postfix version 2.2, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_mailbox_base">virtual_mailbox_base</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> A prefix that the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent prepends to all pathname results from $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a> table lookups. This is a safety measure to ensure that an out of control map doesn't litter the file system with mailboxes. While <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_base">virtual_mailbox_base</a> could be set to "/", this setting isn't recommended. </p> <p> Example: </p> <pre> <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_base">virtual_mailbox_base</a> = /var/mail </pre> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a> (default: $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a>)</b></DT><DD> <p> Postfix is final destination for the specified list of domains; mail is delivered via the $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_transport">virtual_transport</a> mail delivery transport. By default this is the Postfix <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent. The SMTP server validates recipient addresses with $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a> and rejects mail for non-existent recipients. See also the virtual mailbox domain class in the <a href="ADDRESS_CLASS_README.html">ADDRESS_CLASS_README</a> file. </p> <p> This parameter expects the same syntax as the <a href="postconf.5.html#mydestination">mydestination</a> configuration parameter. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. The default value is backwards compatible with Postfix version 1.1. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_mailbox_limit">virtual_mailbox_limit</a> (default: 51200000)</b></DT><DD> <p> The maximal size in bytes of an individual mailbox or maildir file, or zero (no limit). </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_mailbox_lock">virtual_mailbox_lock</a> (default: see "postconf -d" output)</b></DT><DD> <p> How to lock a UNIX-style <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> mailbox before attempting delivery. For a list of available file locking methods, use the "<b>postconf -l</b>" command. </p> <p> This setting is ignored with <b>maildir</b> style delivery, because such deliveries are safe without application-level locks. </p> <p> Note 1: the <b>dotlock</b> method requires that the recipient UID or GID has write access to the parent directory of the recipient's mailbox file. </p> <p> Note 2: the default setting of this parameter is system dependent. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_mailbox_maps">virtual_mailbox_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with all valid addresses in the domains that match $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a>. </p> <p> In a lookup table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld" to match any user in the specified domain that does not have a specific "user@domain.tld" entry. </p> <p> The <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent uses this table to look up the per-recipient mailbox or maildir pathname. If the lookup result ends in a slash ("/"), maildir-style delivery is carried out, otherwise the path is assumed to specify a UNIX-style mailbox file. Note that $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_base">virtual_mailbox_base</a> is unconditionally prepended to this path. </p> <p> When a recipient address has an optional address extension (user+foo@domain.tld), the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent looks up the full address first, and when the lookup fails, it looks up the unextended address (user@domain.tld). </p> <p> Note 1: for security reasons, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution of $1 etc. in regular expression lookup tables, because that would open a security hole. </p> <p> Note 2: for security reasons, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent will silently ignore requests to use the <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxymap(8)</a> server. Instead it will open the table directly. Before Postfix version 2.2, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_maps">virtual_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Optional lookup tables with a) names of domains for which all addresses are aliased to addresses in other local or remote domains, and b) addresses that are aliased to addresses in other local or remote domains. Available before Postfix version 2.0. With Postfix version 2.0 and later, this is replaced by separate controls: <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_domains">virtual_alias_domains</a> and <a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_alias_maps">virtual_alias_maps</a>. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_minimum_uid">virtual_minimum_uid</a> (default: 100)</b></DT><DD> <p> The minimum user ID value that the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent accepts as a result from $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_uid_maps">virtual_uid_maps</a> table lookup. Returned values less than this will be rejected, and the message will be deferred. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_transport">virtual_transport</a> (default: virtual)</b></DT><DD> <p> The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for final delivery to domains listed with $<a href="postconf.5.html#virtual_mailbox_domains">virtual_mailbox_domains</a>. This information can be overruled with the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> table. </p> <p> Specify a string of the form <i>transport:nexthop</i>, where <i>transport</i> is the name of a mail delivery transport defined in <a href="master.5.html">master.cf</a>. The <i>:nexthop</i> part is optional. For more details see the <a href="transport.5.html">transport(5)</a> manual page. </p> <p> This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. </p> </DD> <DT><b><a name="virtual_uid_maps">virtual_uid_maps</a> (default: empty)</b></DT><DD> <p> Lookup tables with the per-recipient user ID that the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent uses while writing to the recipient's mailbox. </p> <p> In a lookup table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld" to match any user in the specified domain that does not have a specific "user@domain.tld" entry. </p> <p> When a recipient address has an optional address extension (user+foo@domain.tld), the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent looks up the full address first, and when the lookup fails, it looks up the unextended address (user@domain.tld). </p> <p> Note 1: for security reasons, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution of $1 etc. in regular expression lookup tables, because that would open a security hole. </p> <p> Note 2: for security reasons, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent will silently ignore requests to use the <a href="proxymap.8.html">proxymap(8)</a> server. Instead it will open the table directly. Before Postfix version 2.2, the <a href="virtual.8.html">virtual(8)</a> delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error. </p> </DD> </dl> </body> </html>